blob: 18c4047189441ba31e2d75f5625d8517bb833242 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau442e8342010-11-11 23:29:35 +01007 2010/11/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
438 - nbproc
439 - pidfile
440 - uid
441 - ulimit-n
442 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200443 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200444 - node
445 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100446 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100447
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 * Performance tuning
449 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100450 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 - noepoll
452 - nokqueue
453 - nopoll
454 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100455 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200456 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200457 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200458 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100459 - tune.maxaccept
460 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200461 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100462 - tune.rcvbuf.client
463 - tune.rcvbuf.server
464 - tune.sndbuf.client
465 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Debugging
468 - debug
469 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200470
471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004723.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200473------------------------------------
474
475chroot <jail dir>
476 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
477 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
478 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
479 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
480 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
481 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100482
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200483daemon
484 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
485 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
486 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
487
488gid <number>
489 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
490 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
491 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
492 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100493
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200494group <group name>
495 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
496 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100497
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200498log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
500 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100501 configured with "log global".
502
503 <address> can be one of:
504
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100505 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100506 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
507 port).
508
509 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
510 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
511 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
512 writeable).
513
514 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515
516 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
517 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
518 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
519
520 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200521 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
522 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
523 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
524 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
525 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
526 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527
528 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
529
530nbproc <number>
531 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
532 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
533 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
534 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
535 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
536
537pidfile <pidfile>
538 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
539 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
540 starting the process. See also "daemon".
541
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200542stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200543 [level <level>]
544
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200545 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
546 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100547 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200548 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
549
550 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
551 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
552 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
553 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
554 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
555
556 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
557 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
558 counters).
559
560 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
561 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100562
563 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
564 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
565 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
566 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
567 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
568 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
569 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200570
571stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
572 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
573 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100574 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200575
576stats maxconn <connections>
577 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
578 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
579
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580uid <number>
581 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
582 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
583 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
584 one. See also "gid" and "user".
585
586ulimit-n <number>
587 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
588 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
589 option.
590
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100591unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
592 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
593
594 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
595 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
596 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
597 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
598 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
599 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
600 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
601 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
602 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
603 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605user <user name>
606 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
607 See also "uid" and "group".
608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200609node <name>
610 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
611
612 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
613 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
614 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
615 traffic.
616
617description <text>
618 Add a text that describes the instance.
619
620 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
621 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
622 "<" and ">" characters.
623
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006253.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626-----------------------
627
628maxconn <number>
629 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
630 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
631 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
632 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
633
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100634maxpipes <number>
635 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
636 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
637 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
638 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
639 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
640 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642noepoll
643 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
644 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
645 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
646
647nokqueue
648 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
649 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
650 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
651
652nopoll
653 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
654 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100655 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
657 "nokqueue".
658
659nosepoll
660 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
661 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
662 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
663
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100664nosplice
665 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
666 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
667 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100668 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100669 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
670 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
671 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
672 "option splice-response".
673
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200674spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
675 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
676 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
677 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
678 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
679 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
680
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200681tune.bufsize <number>
682 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
683 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
684 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
685 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
686 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
687 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
688 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
689 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
690
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200691tune.chksize <number>
692 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
693 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
694 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
695 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
696 checks whenever possible.
697
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100698tune.maxaccept <number>
699 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
700 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
701 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100702 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100703 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
704 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100705 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100706 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
707
708tune.maxpollevents <number>
709 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
710 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
711 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
712 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
713 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
714
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200715tune.maxrewrite <number>
716 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
717 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
718 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
719 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
720 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
721 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
722 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
723 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
724 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
725 bufsize.
726
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100727tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
728tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
729 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
730 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
731 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
732 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
733 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
734 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
735 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
736
737tune.sndbuf.client <number>
738tune.sndbuf.server <number>
739 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
740 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
741 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
742 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
743 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
744 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
745 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
746 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
747 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
748 notifying haproxy again.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.3. Debugging
752--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753
754debug
755 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
756 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
757 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
758 system startup.
759
760quiet
761 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
762 line argument "-q".
763
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007653.4. Userlists
766--------------
767It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
768http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
769it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
770
771userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100772 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100773 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
774
775group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100776 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100777 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
778 proceeded by "users" keyword.
779
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100780user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
781 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100782 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
783 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100784 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
785 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100786 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
787 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
788
789
790 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100791 userlist L1
792 group G1 users tiger,scott
793 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100794
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100795 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
796 user scott insecure-password elgato
797 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100798
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100799 userlist L2
800 group G1
801 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100802
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100803 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
804 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
805 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100806
807 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200808
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200809
8103.5. Peers
811--------------
812It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
813haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
814pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
815identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
816or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
817Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
818known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
819the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
820process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
821during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
822tables.
823
824peers <peersect>
825 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
826 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
827
828peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
829 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
830 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
831 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
832 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
833 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
834 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
835
836 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
837 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
838
839 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
840 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
841 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
842 across all peers.
843
844Example:
845 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100846 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
847 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
848 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200849
850 backend mybackend
851 mode tcp
852 balance roundrobin
853 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
854 stick on src
855
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100856 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
857 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200858
859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008604. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200861----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200863Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
864 - defaults <name>
865 - frontend <name>
866 - backend <name>
867 - listen <name>
868
869A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
870its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
871section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100872section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200873
874A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
875connections.
876
877A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
878to forward incoming connections.
879
880A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
881parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
882
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100883All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
884'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
885case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
886
887Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
888logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
889proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
890However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
891name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
892
893Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
894and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100895bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100896protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
897modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
898arbitrary criteria.
899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009014.1. Proxy keywords matrix
902--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200904The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
905limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
906they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
907limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100908marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200909option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200910and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
911with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
912specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100913
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200914
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100915 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
916------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
917acl - X X X
918appsession - - X X
919backlog X X X -
920balance X - X X
921bind - X X -
922bind-process X X X X
923block - X X X
924capture cookie - X X -
925capture request header - X X -
926capture response header - X X -
927clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
928contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
929cookie X - X X
930default-server X - X X
931default_backend X X X -
932description - X X X
933disabled X X X X
934dispatch - - X X
935enabled X X X X
936errorfile X X X X
937errorloc X X X X
938errorloc302 X X X X
939-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
940errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200941force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100942fullconn X - X X
943grace X X X X
944hash-type X - X X
945http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100946http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200947http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100948http-request - X X X
949id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200950ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100951log X X X X
952maxconn X X X -
953mode X X X X
954monitor fail - X X -
955monitor-net X X X -
956monitor-uri X X X -
957option abortonclose (*) X - X X
958option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
959option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
960option allbackups (*) X - X X
961option checkcache (*) X - X X
962option clitcpka (*) X X X -
963option contstats (*) X X X -
964option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
965option dontlognull (*) X X X -
966option forceclose (*) X X X X
967-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
968option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200969option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100970option http-server-close (*) X X X X
971option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
972option httpchk X - X X
973option httpclose (*) X X X X
974option httplog X X X X
975option http_proxy (*) X X X X
976option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200977option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100978option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
979option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
980option logasap (*) X X X -
981option mysql-check X - X X
982option nolinger (*) X X X X
983option originalto X X X X
984option persist (*) X - X X
985option redispatch (*) X - X X
986option smtpchk X - X X
987option socket-stats (*) X X X -
988option splice-auto (*) X X X X
989option splice-request (*) X X X X
990option splice-response (*) X X X X
991option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
992option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
993-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
994option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
995option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
996option tcpka X X X X
997option tcplog X X X X
998option transparent (*) X - X X
999persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1000rate-limit sessions X X X -
1001redirect - X X X
1002redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1003redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1004reqadd - X X X
1005reqallow - X X X
1006reqdel - X X X
1007reqdeny - X X X
1008reqiallow - X X X
1009reqidel - X X X
1010reqideny - X X X
1011reqipass - X X X
1012reqirep - X X X
1013reqisetbe - X X X
1014reqitarpit - X X X
1015reqpass - X X X
1016reqrep - X X X
1017-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1018reqsetbe - X X X
1019reqtarpit - X X X
1020retries X - X X
1021rspadd - X X X
1022rspdel - X X X
1023rspdeny - X X X
1024rspidel - X X X
1025rspideny - X X X
1026rspirep - X X X
1027rsprep - X X X
1028server - - X X
1029source X - X X
1030srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001031stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001032stats auth X - X X
1033stats enable X - X X
1034stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001035stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001036stats realm X - X X
1037stats refresh X - X X
1038stats scope X - X X
1039stats show-desc X - X X
1040stats show-legends X - X X
1041stats show-node X - X X
1042stats uri X - X X
1043-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1044stick match - - X X
1045stick on - - X X
1046stick store-request - - X X
1047stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001048tcp-request connection - X X -
1049tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001050tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001051tcp-response content - - X X
1052tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001053timeout check X - X X
1054timeout client X X X -
1055timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1056timeout connect X - X X
1057timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1058timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1059timeout http-request X X X X
1060timeout queue X - X X
1061timeout server X - X X
1062timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1063timeout tarpit X X X X
1064transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1065use_backend - X X -
1066------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1067 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010704.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1071---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001072
1073This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1074
1075
1076acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1077 Declare or complete an access list.
1078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1079 no | yes | yes | yes
1080 Example:
1081 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1082 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1083 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001085 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001086
1087
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001088appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1089 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001090 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1092 no | no | yes | yes
1093 Arguments :
1094 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1095 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1096
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001097 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001098 checked in each cookie value.
1099
1100 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1101 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1102 milliseconds.
1103
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001104 request-learn
1105 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1106 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1107 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1108 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1109 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1110 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1111
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001112 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1113 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1114 data following this prefix.
1115
1116 Example :
1117 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1118
1119 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1120 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1121
1122 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1123 2 modes are currently supported :
1124 - path-parameters :
1125 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1126 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1127 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1128 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1129 - query-string :
1130 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1131 query string.
1132
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001133 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1134 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1135 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1136 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001137 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1138 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1139 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001140 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1141 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1142
1143 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1144
1145 Example :
1146 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1147
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001148 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001149 and "ignore-persist"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001150
1151
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001152backlog <conns>
1153 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1155 yes | yes | yes | no
1156 Arguments :
1157 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1158 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1159 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1160
1161 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1162 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1163 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1164 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1165 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1166 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1167 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1168 backlog parameter.
1169
1170 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1171 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1172 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1173
1174 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1175
1176
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001177balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001178balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001179 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1181 yes | no | yes | yes
1182 Arguments :
1183 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1184 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1185 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1186 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1187
1188 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1189 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1190 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1191 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001192 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1193 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1194 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1195 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1196 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1197 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1198 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1199 it, so that you don't worry.
1200
1201 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1202 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1203 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1204 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1205 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1206 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1207 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1208 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001209
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001210 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1211 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1212 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1213 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1214 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1215 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1216 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1217 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1218
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001219 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1220 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1221 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1222 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1223 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1224 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1225 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1226 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001227 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001228 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001229 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1230 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1231 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232
1233 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1234 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1235 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1236 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1237 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1238 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1239 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001240 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1241 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1242 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001244 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1245 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1246 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1247 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1248 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1249 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1250 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1251 URIs start with a leading "/".
1252
1253 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1254 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1255 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1256 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001258 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001259 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1260
1261 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1262 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1263 when the question mark indicating a query string ('?') is not
1264 present in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1265 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1266 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1267 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1268 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1269 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1270 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1271 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1272 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1273 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1274 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1275 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1276 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1277 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1278 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1279 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1280 be randomly balanced if at all.
1281
1282 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1283 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1284 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1285 server will receive the request.
1286
1287 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1288 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1289 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1290 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1291 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001292 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1293 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1294 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001295
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001296 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1297 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1298 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001299 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001300 algorithm is applied instead.
1301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001302 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001303 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1304 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1305 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1306
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001307 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1308 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1309 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1310
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001311 rdp-cookie
1312 rdp-cookie(name)
1313 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1314 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1315 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1316 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1317 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1318 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001319 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001320 used instead.
1321
1322 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1323 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1324 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1325 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1326
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001327 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1328 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1329 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1330
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001331 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001332 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1333 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001334
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001335 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001336 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001337
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001338 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1339 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1340 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001341
1342 Examples :
1343 balance roundrobin
1344 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001345 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001346 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1347 balance hdr(host)
1348 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001349
1350 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1351 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001353 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001354 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1355 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1356 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1357 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1358
1359 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1360 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1361 defaults to 16 kB.
1362
1363 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1364 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1365
1366 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1367 Round Robin.
1368
1369 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1370 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1371 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1372 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1373
1374 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1375
1376 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001377 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001378 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1379 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1380 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001381
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001382 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1383 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001384
1385
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001386bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1387bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1388bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1389bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1390bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1391bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1392bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001393bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001394bind /<path> [, ...]
1395bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1396bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1397bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001398 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1400 no | yes | yes | no
1401 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001402 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1403 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1404 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1405 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
1406 special address "0.0.0.0".
1407
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001408 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1409 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001410 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1411 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1412 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001413 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1414 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1415 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1416 the range.
1417
1418 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1419 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1420 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1421 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1422 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1423 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1424 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1425 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1426 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001427
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001428 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1429 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1430 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1431 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1432 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1433 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1434 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1435 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1436
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001437 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1438 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1439 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1440 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1441 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1442 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1443 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1444 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001445 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1446 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001447
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001448 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1449 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1450 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1451 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1452 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1453 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
1454 work on other operating systems. The commonly advertised
1455 value on Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP).
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001456 This parameter is only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001457
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001458 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1459 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1460 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1461 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001462
1463 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1464
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001465 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1466 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1467 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1468 simply ignore this.
1469
1470 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1471 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1472 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1473 simply ignore this.
1474
1475 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1476 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1477 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1478 this.
1479
1480 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1481 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1482 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1483 this.
1484
1485 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1486 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1487 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1488 this.
1489
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001490 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1491 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1492 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001493 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001494 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1495 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1496 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1497 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001498 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1499 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001500
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001501 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001502 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1503 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1504 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1505 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1506 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1507 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1508 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1509 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1510 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1511 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1512 with front firewalls which would see an established
1513 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1514
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001515 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1516 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1517 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1518 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1519 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1520 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1521 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1522 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1523 This keyword combined with support from external components
1524 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1525 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1526 not even always usable.
1527
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001528 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1529 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1530 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1531 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1532 in a frontend.
1533
1534 Example :
1535 listen http_proxy
1536 bind :80,:443
1537 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001538 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001539
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001540 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001541 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001542
1543
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001544bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1545 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1547 yes | yes | yes | yes
1548 Arguments :
1549 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1550 may be used to override a default value.
1551
1552 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1553 option may be combined with other numbers.
1554
1555 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1556 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1557 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1558 missing from all processes.
1559
1560 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1561 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1562 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1563 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1564
1565 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1566 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1567 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1568 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1569 and 'even' instances.
1570
1571 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1572 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1573 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1574 32.
1575
1576 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1577 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1578
1579 Example :
1580 listen app_ip1
1581 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001582 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001583
1584 listen app_ip2
1585 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001586 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001587
1588 listen management
1589 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001590 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001591
1592 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1593
1594
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001595block { if | unless } <condition>
1596 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1598 no | yes | yes | yes
1599
1600 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1601 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001602 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001603 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1604 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1605 "block" statements per instance.
1606
1607 Example:
1608 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1609 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1610 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1611 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001613 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001614
1615
1616capture cookie <name> len <length>
1617 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1619 no | yes | yes | no
1620 Arguments :
1621 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1622 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1623 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1624 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1625 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1626
1627 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1628 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1629 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1630 right if it exceeds <length>.
1631
1632 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1633 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1634 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1635 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1636
1637 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1638 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1639 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1640
1641 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1642 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1643 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1644 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001645 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1647
1648 Example:
1649 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1650
1651 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001652 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001653
1654
1655capture request header <name> len <length>
1656 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1658 no | yes | yes | no
1659 Arguments :
1660 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001661 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001662 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1663 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1664 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1665
1666 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1667 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1668 it exceeds <length>.
1669
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001670 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001671 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1672 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001673 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1674 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1675 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1676 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001677 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001678 environments to find where the request came from.
1679
1680 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1681 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1682 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1683 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001684
1685 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1686 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1687 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1688 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1689
1690 Example:
1691 capture request header Host len 15
1692 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1693 capture request header Referrer len 15
1694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001695 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001696 about logging.
1697
1698
1699capture response header <name> len <length>
1700 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1702 no | yes | yes | no
1703 Arguments :
1704 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001705 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001706 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1707 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1708 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1709
1710 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1711 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1712 it exceeds <length>.
1713
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001714 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001715 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1716 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1717 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001718 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1719 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1720 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1721 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001722
1723 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1724 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1725 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1726 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1727
1728 Example:
1729 capture response header Content-length len 9
1730 capture response header Location len 15
1731
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001732 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733 about logging.
1734
1735
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001736clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001737 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1739 yes | yes | yes | no
1740 Arguments :
1741 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1742 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1743 as explained at the top of this document.
1744
1745 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1746 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1747 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1748 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1749 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1750 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1751 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1752 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001753 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001754 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1755 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1756
1757 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1758 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1759 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1760 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1761 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1762 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1763
1764 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1765 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1766
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001767 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1768 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001769
1770
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001771contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001772 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1774 yes | no | yes | yes
1775 Arguments :
1776 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1777 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1778 as explained at the top of this document.
1779
1780 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001781 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001782 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1784 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1785 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1786 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1787
1788 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1789 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1790 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1791 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1792 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1793 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1794
1795 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1796 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1797 instead.
1798
1799 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1800 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1801
1802
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001803cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001804 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001805 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1808 yes | no | yes | yes
1809 Arguments :
1810 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1811 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1812 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1813 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1814 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1815 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1816 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1817 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1818 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1819
1820 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1821 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1822 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1823 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1824 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1825 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1826 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1827 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1828 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1829 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1830 "insert" and "prefix".
1831
1832 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001833 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001834
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001835 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001836 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1837 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1838 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1839 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1840 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1841 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1842 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1843 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1844 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1845 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001846
1847 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1848 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1849 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1850 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1851 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1852 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1853 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1854 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1855 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1856 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1857 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1858
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001859 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1860 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1861 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001862 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1863 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1864 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1865 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001866
1867 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1868 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1869 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1870 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1871 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1872 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1873 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1874 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1875 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1876
1877 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1878 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1879 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1880 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1881 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1882 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1883 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1884 persistence cookie in the cache.
1885 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1886
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001887 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1888 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1889 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1890 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1891 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1892 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1893 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1894 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1895 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1896 they logout.
1897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001898 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001899 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001900 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1901 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1902 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1903 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1904 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1905 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001906
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001907 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1908 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1909 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1910 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1911 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1912 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1913 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1914 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1915 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1916 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1917 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1918 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1919 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1920 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1921 the site.
1922
1923 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1924 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1925 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1926 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1927 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1928 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1929 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1930 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1931 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1932 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1933 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1934 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1935 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1936 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1937 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1938 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1939
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001940 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1941 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1942 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1943 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001945 Examples :
1946 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1947 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1948 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001949 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001951 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001952 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001953
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001954
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001955default-server [param*]
1956 Change default options for a server in a backend
1957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1958 yes | no | yes | yes
1959 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001960 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1961 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1962 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1963 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001964
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001965 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001966 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1967
1968 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001971default_backend <backend>
1972 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1974 yes | yes | yes | no
1975 Arguments :
1976 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1977
1978 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1979 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1980 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1981 will catch all undetermined requests.
1982
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001983 Example :
1984
1985 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
1986 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
1987 default_backend dynamic
1988
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001989 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
1990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001991
1992disabled
1993 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1995 yes | yes | yes | yes
1996 Arguments : none
1997
1998 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
1999 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2000 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2001 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2002 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2003 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2004 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2005
2006 See also : "enabled"
2007
2008
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002009dispatch <address>:<port>
2010 Set a default server address
2011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2012 no | no | yes | yes
2013 Arguments : none
2014
2015 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2016 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2017 during start-up.
2018
2019 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2020 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2021 possible with normal servers.
2022
2023 The "disabled" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
2024 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2025 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2026 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2027 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2028
2029 See also : "server"
2030
2031
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002032enabled
2033 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2035 yes | yes | yes | yes
2036 Arguments : none
2037
2038 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2039 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2040
2041 See also : "disabled"
2042
2043
2044errorfile <code> <file>
2045 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2047 yes | yes | yes | yes
2048 Arguments :
2049 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2050 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2051
2052 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002053 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002055 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2056 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057
2058 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2059 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2060 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2061
2062 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2063 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2064 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2065 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2066
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002067 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2068 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2069 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2070 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2071 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2072 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2073
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2075 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2076 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002077 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2079
2080 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2081
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002082 Example :
2083 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2084 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2085 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2086
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002087
2088errorloc <code> <url>
2089errorloc302 <code> <url>
2090 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2092 yes | yes | yes | yes
2093 Arguments :
2094 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2095 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2096
2097 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2098 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2099 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2100 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2101 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2102
2103 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2104 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2105 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2106
2107 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2108 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2109 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2110 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2111 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2112 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2113 request.
2114
2115 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2116
2117
2118errorloc303 <code> <url>
2119 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2121 yes | yes | yes | yes
2122 Arguments :
2123 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2124 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2125
2126 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2127 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2128 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2129 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2130 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2131
2132 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2133 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2134 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2135
2136 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2137 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2138 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2139 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002140 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002141
2142 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2143
2144
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002145force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2146 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2148 no | yes | yes | yes
2149
2150 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2151 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2152 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2153 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2154 marked down for maintenance operations.
2155
2156 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2157 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2158 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2159 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2160 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2161 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2162 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2163 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2164 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2165
2166 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2167 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2168 is used.
2169
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002170 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002171 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002172
2173
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002174fullconn <conns>
2175 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2177 yes | no | yes | yes
2178 Arguments :
2179 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2180 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2181
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002182 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002183 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002184 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002185 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2186 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2187 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2188 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2189 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002190 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002191
2192 Example :
2193 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2194 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2195 # connections.
2196 backend dynamic
2197 fullconn 10000
2198 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2199 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2200
2201 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2202
2203
2204grace <time>
2205 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002207 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002208 Arguments :
2209 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2210 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2211 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2212
2213 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2214 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002215 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002216 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2217
2218 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2219 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2220 simplify it.
2221
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002222
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002223hash-type <method>
2224 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2226 yes | no | yes | yes
2227 Arguments :
2228 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2229 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2230 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2231 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2232 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2233 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2234 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2235 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2236 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2237
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002238 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2239 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2240 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2241 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2242 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2243 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2244 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2245 this value.
2246
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002247 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2248 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2249 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2250 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2251 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2252 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2253 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2254 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2255 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2256 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2257 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2258 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2259 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2260
2261 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2262
2263 See also : "balance", "server"
2264
2265
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002266http-check disable-on-404
2267 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002269 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002270 Arguments : none
2271
2272 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2273 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2274 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2275 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2276 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2277 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2278 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2279 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002280 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2281 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2282 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2283
2284 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2285
2286
2287http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2288 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2290 no | no | yes | yes
2291 Arguments :
2292 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2293 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2294 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2295 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2296 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2297 details on the supported keywords.
2298
2299 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2300 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2301 with the usual backslash ('\').
2302
2303 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2304 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2305 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2306 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2307 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2308
2309 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2310 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2311 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2312 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2313 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2314
2315 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2316 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2317 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2318 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2319 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2320 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2321
2322 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2323 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2324 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2325 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2326 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2327 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2328 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2329 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2330 trace).
2331
2332 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2333 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2334 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2335 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2336 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2337 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2338 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2339 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2340
2341 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2342 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2343 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2344 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2345 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2346 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2347 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2348 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2349
2350 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2351 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2352
2353 Examples :
2354 # only accept status 200 as valid
2355 http-request expect status 200
2356
2357 # consider SQL errors as errors
2358 http-request expect ! string SQL\ Error
2359
2360 # consider status 5xx only as errors
2361 http-request expect ! rstatus ^5
2362
2363 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
2364 http-request expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002366 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002367
2368
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002369http-check send-state
2370 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2372 yes | no | yes | yes
2373 Arguments : none
2374
2375 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2376 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2377 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2378 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2379 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2380
2381 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2382 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2383 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2384 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2385 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2386 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2387 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2388 checked in multiple backends.
2389
2390 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2391 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2392
2393 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2394 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2395 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2396 one fails.
2397
2398 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2399 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2400 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2401
2402 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2403 server's queue.
2404
2405 Example of a header received by the application server :
2406 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2407 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2408
2409 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2410
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002411http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002412 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002413 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2414
2415 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2416 no | yes | yes | yes
2417
2418 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2419 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2420 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002421 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2422 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002423 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2424
2425 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2426 instance.
2427
2428 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002429 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2430 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2431 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002432
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002433 http-request allow if nagios
2434 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2435 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2436 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002437
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002438 Example:
2439 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002440
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002441 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002442
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002443 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2444 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002446id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002447 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2449 no | yes | yes | yes
2450 Arguments : none
2451
2452 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2453 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2454 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002455
2456
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002457ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2458 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2459 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2460 no | yes | yes | yes
2461
2462 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2463 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2464 and running).
2465
2466 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2467 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2468 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2469 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2470 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2471
2472 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2473 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2474
2475 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2476 "unless" condition is met.
2477
2478 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2479
2480
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002481log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002482log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002483 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2485 yes | yes | yes | yes
2486 Arguments :
2487 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2488 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2489 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2490 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2491 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2492 parameter.
2493
2494 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2495 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2496
2497 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2498 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2499 standard syslog port).
2500
2501 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2502 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2503 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2504 appropriately writeable).
2505
2506 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2507
2508 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2509 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2510 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2511
2512 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2513 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2514 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002515 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2516 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2517 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2518 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2519 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002520
2521 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2522
2523 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2524 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2525 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2526
2527 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002528 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2529 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2530 "info".
2531
2532 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2533 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2534 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2535 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2536
2537 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2538 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002539
2540 Example :
2541 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002542 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2543 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002544
2545
2546maxconn <conns>
2547 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2549 yes | yes | yes | no
2550 Arguments :
2551 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2552 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2553 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2554 closes.
2555
2556 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2557 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2558 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2559 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2560 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2561 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2562 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2563 properly tuned.
2564
2565 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2566 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2567 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2568
2569 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2570
2571
2572mode { tcp|http|health }
2573 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2575 yes | yes | yes | yes
2576 Arguments :
2577 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2578 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2579 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2580 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2581
2582 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2583 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2584 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2585 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2586 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2587
2588 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2589 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2590 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2591 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2592 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2593 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2594
2595 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2596 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2597 will be refused.
2598
2599 Example :
2600 defaults http_instances
2601 mode http
2602
2603 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002605
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002606monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002607 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2609 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002610 Arguments :
2611 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2612 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002613 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002614 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2615 backend and its backup.
2616
2617 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2618 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2619 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2620 servers in a list of backends.
2621
2622 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2623 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2624 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2625 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2626 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2627 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2628 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002629 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002630
2631 Example:
2632 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002633 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2635 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2636 monitor-uri /site_alive
2637 monitor fail if site_dead
2638
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002639 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri"
2640
2641
2642monitor-net <source>
2643 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2645 yes | yes | yes | no
2646 Arguments :
2647 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2648 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2649 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2650 followed by a mask.
2651
2652 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2653 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002654 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002655 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2656
2657 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2658 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2659 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2660 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2661 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2662
2663 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2664 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2665 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2666 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2667 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2668
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002669 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2670 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2671
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002672 Example :
2673 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2674 frontend www
2675 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2676
2677 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2678
2679
2680monitor-uri <uri>
2681 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2683 yes | yes | yes | no
2684 Arguments :
2685 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2686 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2687
2688 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2689 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2690 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2691 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2692 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2693 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2694 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2695 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2696
2697 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2698 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2699 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2700 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2701 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2702 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2703
2704 Example :
2705 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2706 frontend www
2707 mode http
2708 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2709
2710 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2711
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002713option abortonclose
2714no option abortonclose
2715 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2717 yes | no | yes | yes
2718 Arguments : none
2719
2720 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2721 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2722 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2723 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002724 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002725 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2726 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2727 encountered while delivering the response.
2728
2729 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2730 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2731 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2732 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2733 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2734 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002735 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002736 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002737 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002738 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2739 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2740 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2741
2742 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2743 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2744 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2745 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2746 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2747 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2748 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2749 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002750 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002751
2752 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2753 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2754
2755 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2756
2757
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002758option accept-invalid-http-request
2759no option accept-invalid-http-request
2760 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2762 yes | yes | yes | no
2763 Arguments : none
2764
2765 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2766 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2767 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2768 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2769 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2770 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2771 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2772 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2773 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2774
2775 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2776 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2777 been confirmed.
2778
2779 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2780 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2781 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2782 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2783
2784 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2785 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2786
2787 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2788 stats socket.
2789
2790
2791option accept-invalid-http-response
2792no option accept-invalid-http-response
2793 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2795 yes | no | yes | yes
2796 Arguments : none
2797
2798 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2799 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2800 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2801 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2802 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2803 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2804 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2805 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2806 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2807
2808 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2809 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2810 been confirmed.
2811
2812 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2813 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2814 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2815 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2816
2817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2819
2820 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2821 stats socket.
2822
2823
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002824option allbackups
2825no option allbackups
2826 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 yes | no | yes | yes
2829 Arguments : none
2830
2831 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2832 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2833 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2834 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2835 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2836 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2837 order between the backup servers anymore.
2838
2839 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2840 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2841
2842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2844
2845
2846option checkcache
2847no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002848 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2850 yes | no | yes | yes
2851 Arguments : none
2852
2853 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2854 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002855 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002856 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2857 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2858 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2859
2860 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002861 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002862 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002863 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2864 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002865 to the client are :
2866 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002867 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002868 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002869 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2870 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2871 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2872 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2873 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2874 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2875 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2876 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2877 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2878 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2879 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2880
2881 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002882 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002883 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002884 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002885 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2886
2887 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2888 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002889 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002890 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2891
2892 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2893 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2894
2895
2896option clitcpka
2897no option clitcpka
2898 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2900 yes | yes | yes | no
2901 Arguments : none
2902
2903 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2904 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2905 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2906 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2907
2908 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2909 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2910 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2911 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2912
2913 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2914 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2915 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2916 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2917 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2918
2919 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2920
2921 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2922 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2923 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2924
2925 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2926 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2927
2928 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2929
2930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002931option contstats
2932 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | yes | yes | no
2935 Arguments : none
2936
2937 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2938 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2939 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2940 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2941 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2942 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2943 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2944
2945
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002946option dontlog-normal
2947no option dontlog-normal
2948 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2950 yes | yes | yes | no
2951 Arguments : none
2952
2953 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2954 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2955 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
2956 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
2957 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
2958 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
2959 logged.
2960
2961 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
2962 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
2963 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
2964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002965 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002966 logging.
2967
2968
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002969option dontlognull
2970no option dontlognull
2971 Enable or disable logging of null connections
2972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2973 yes | yes | yes | no
2974 Arguments : none
2975
2976 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
2977 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
2978 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
2979 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
2980 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
2981 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
2982 which typically corresponds to those probes.
2983
2984 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
2985 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
2986 would not be logged.
2987
2988 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2989 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002991 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002992
2993
2994option forceclose
2995no option forceclose
2996 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
2997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01002998 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002999 Arguments : none
3000
3001 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3002 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3003 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3004 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3005 global session times in the logs.
3006
3007 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003008 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003009 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3010 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3011 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3012 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003013
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003014 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3015 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3016 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3017
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003018 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3019 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3020
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003021 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003022
3023
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003024option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003025 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3027 yes | yes | yes | yes
3028 Arguments :
3029 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3030 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003031 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003032 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003033
3034 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3035 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3036 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3037 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3038 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3039 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3040 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003041 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3042 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3043 possible that the client has already brought one.
3044
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003045 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003046 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003047 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3048 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003049 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3050 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003051
3052 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3053 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3054 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3055 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3056 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3057 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3058 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3059
3060 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003061 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3062 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3063 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003064
3065 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3066 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3067 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3068 when using this option.
3069
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003070 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003071 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3072 frontend www
3073 mode http
3074 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3075
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003076 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3077 backend www
3078 mode http
3079 option forwardfor header X-Client
3080
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003081 See also : "option httpclose"
3082
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003083
3084option http-pretend-keepalive
3085no option http-pretend-keepalive
3086 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3088 yes | yes | yes | yes
3089 Arguments : none
3090
3091 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3092 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3093 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3094 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3095 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3096 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3097 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3098 consider the response complete.
3099
3100 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3101 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3102 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3103 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3104 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3105 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3106
3107 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3108 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3109 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3110 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3111 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3112 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3113 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3114
3115 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3116 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003117 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3118 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3119 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003120
3121 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3122 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3123
3124 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3125
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003126
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003127option http-server-close
3128no option http-server-close
3129 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3131 yes | yes | yes | yes
3132 Arguments : none
3133
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003134 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3135 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3136 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3137 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3138 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3139 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3140 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3141 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3142 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3143 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3144 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3145 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003146
3147 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3148 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3149 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3150 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003151 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3152 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003153
3154 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3155 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003156 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3157 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3158 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003159
3160 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3161 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3162
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003163 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3164 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003165
3166
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003167option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003168no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003169 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3171 yes | yes | yes | no
3172 Arguments : none
3173
3174 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3175 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3176 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3177 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3178 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3179 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3180 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3181
3182 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3183 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3184 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3185 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3186 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3187 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3188 request along its whole life.
3189
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003190 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3191 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3192 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3193 front of an existing proxy.
3194
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003195 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3196
3197 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3198 http-server-close".
3199
3200
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003201option httpchk
3202option httpchk <uri>
3203option httpchk <method> <uri>
3204option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3205 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3207 yes | no | yes | yes
3208 Arguments :
3209 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3210 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3211 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3212 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3213 ones.
3214
3215 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3216 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3217 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3218
3219 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3220 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3221 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3222 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3223 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3224
3225 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3226 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3227 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3228 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3229 the lack of any response.
3230
3231 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3232
3233 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3234 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3235 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3236
3237 Examples :
3238 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3239 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3240 backend https_relay
3241 mode tcp
3242 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3243 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3244
3245 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
3246 "http-check" and the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
3247
3248
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003249option httpclose
3250no option httpclose
3251 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3253 yes | yes | yes | yes
3254 Arguments : none
3255
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003256 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3257 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3258 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3259 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3260 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3261 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3262 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003263
3264 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003265 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3266 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3267 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3268 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3269 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3270 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003271
3272 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3273 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3274 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003275 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3276 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003277
3278 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3279 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3280
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003281 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3282 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003283
3284
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003285option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003286 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3288 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003289 Arguments :
3290 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3291 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3292 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3293 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3294 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003295
3296 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3297 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3298 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3299 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3300 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3301 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3302 ports.
3303
3304 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3305
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003306 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3307 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3308 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3309 by default.
3310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003311 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003312
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003313
3314option http_proxy
3315no option http_proxy
3316 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3318 yes | yes | yes | yes
3319 Arguments : none
3320
3321 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3322 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3323 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3324 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3325 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3326
3327 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3328 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3329 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3330 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
3331 needed to add "option http_close" to ensure that all requests will correctly
3332 be analyzed.
3333
3334 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3335 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3336
3337 Example :
3338 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3339 backend direct_forward
3340 option httpclose
3341 option http_proxy
3342
3343 See also : "option httpclose"
3344
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003345
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003346option ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3347 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3348 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3349 no | yes | yes | yes
3350
3351 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3352 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3353 and running).
3354
3355 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3356 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3357 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3358 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3359 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3360
3361 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3362 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3363
3364 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3365 "unless" condition is met.
3366
3367 See also : "option force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3368
3369
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003370option independant-streams
3371no option independant-streams
3372 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3374 yes | yes | yes | yes
3375 Arguments : none
3376
3377 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3378 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3379 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3380 receive data or not.
3381
3382 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3383 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3384 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3385 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3386 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3387 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3388 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3389 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3390 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3391 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3392 socket buffers.
3393
3394 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3395 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3396 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3397 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3398 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3399
3400 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3401
3402
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003403option ldap-check
3404 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3406 yes | no | yes | yes
3407 Arguments : none
3408
3409 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3410 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3411 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3412 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3413
3414 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3415 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3416
3417 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3418 configure it.
3419
3420 Example :
3421 option ldap-check
3422
3423 See also : "option httpchk"
3424
3425
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003426option log-health-checks
3427no option log-health-checks
3428 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 yes | no | yes | yes
3431 Arguments : none
3432
3433 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3434 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3435 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3436 of additional information is limited.
3437
3438 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3439 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3440
3441 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3442
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003443
3444option log-separate-errors
3445no option log-separate-errors
3446 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3448 yes | yes | yes | no
3449 Arguments : none
3450
3451 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3452 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3453 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3454 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3455 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3456 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3457 provides very important information.
3458
3459 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3460 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3461 error logs.
3462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003463 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003464 logging.
3465
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003466
3467option logasap
3468no option logasap
3469 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3471 yes | yes | yes | no
3472 Arguments : none
3473
3474 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3475 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3476 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3477 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3478 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3479 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3480 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003481 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003482 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3483 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3484
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003485 Examples :
3486 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3487 mode http
3488 option httplog
3489 option logasap
3490 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3491
3492 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3493 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3494 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3495 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003497 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003498 logging.
3499
3500
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003501option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3502 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3504 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003505 Arguments :
3506 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3507 to MySQL server.
3508
3509 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3510 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3511 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3512 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3513 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3514 in the MySQL table, like this :
3515
3516 USE mysql;
3517 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3518 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3519
3520 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3521 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3522 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3523 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3524 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3525 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3526 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3527 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3528 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3529
3530 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3531 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003532
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003533 The check requires MySQL >=4.0, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003534
3535 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3536 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3537 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3538 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3539 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3540 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3541
3542 See also: "option httpchk"
3543
3544
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003545option nolinger
3546no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003547 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003548 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3549 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003550 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003551
3552 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3553 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3554 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3555 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3556 connections.
3557
3558 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3559 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3560 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3561 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3562 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3563 this too.
3564
3565 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3566 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3567 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3568
3569 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3570 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3571 for servers.
3572
3573 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3574 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3575
3576
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003577option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3578 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3580 yes | yes | yes | yes
3581 Arguments :
3582 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3583 matching <network>
3584 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3585 header name.
3586
3587 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3588 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3589 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3590 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3591 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3592 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3593 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3594 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3595 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3596 possible that the client has already brought one.
3597
3598 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3599 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3600 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3601 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3602 header and requires different one.
3603
3604 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3605 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3606 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3607 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3608 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3609 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3610 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3611
3612 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3613 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3614 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3615 both are defined.
3616
3617 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3618 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3619 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3620 when using this option.
3621
3622 Examples :
3623 # Original Destination address
3624 frontend www
3625 mode http
3626 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3627
3628 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3629 backend www
3630 mode http
3631 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3632
3633 See also : "option httpclose"
3634
3635
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003636option persist
3637no option persist
3638 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3639 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3640 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003641 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003642
3643 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3644 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3645 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3646 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3647 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3648 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3649 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3650 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3651 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3652 redirected to another valid server.
3653
3654 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3655 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3656
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003657 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003658
3659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003660option redispatch
3661no option redispatch
3662 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3663 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3664 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003665 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003666
3667 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3668 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3669 be able to access the service anymore.
3670
3671 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3672 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3673
3674 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3675 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3676 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003678 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3679 "redisp" keywords.
3680
3681 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3682 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3683
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003684 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003685
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003686
3687option smtpchk
3688option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3689 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3691 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003692 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003693 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3694 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3695 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3696
3697 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3698 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3699 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3700
3701 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3702 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3703 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3704 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3705 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3706 dead server.
3707
3708 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3709 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3710 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3711 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3712
3713 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3714 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3715 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3716 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3717 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3718
3719 Example :
3720 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3721
3722 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003724
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003725option socket-stats
3726no option socket-stats
3727
3728 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3730 yes | yes | yes | no
3731
3732 Arguments : none
3733
3734
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003735option splice-auto
3736no option splice-auto
3737 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | yes | yes | yes
3740 Arguments : none
3741
3742 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3743 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3744 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3745 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003746 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003747 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3748 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3749 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3750 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3751
3752 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3753 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3754 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3755 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3756 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3757 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3758 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3759 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3760 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3761 keyword.
3762
3763 Example :
3764 option splice-auto
3765
3766 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3767 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3768
3769 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3770 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3771
3772
3773option splice-request
3774no option splice-request
3775 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3777 yes | yes | yes | yes
3778 Arguments : none
3779
3780 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3781 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3782 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3783 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3784 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3785 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3786
3787 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3788
3789 Example :
3790 option splice-request
3791
3792 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3793 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3794
3795 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3796 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3797
3798
3799option splice-response
3800no option splice-response
3801 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3803 yes | yes | yes | yes
3804 Arguments : none
3805
3806 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3807 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3808 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3809 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3810 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3811 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3812
3813 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3814
3815 Example :
3816 option splice-response
3817
3818 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3819 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3820
3821 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3822 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3823
3824
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003825option srvtcpka
3826no option srvtcpka
3827 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3829 yes | no | yes | yes
3830 Arguments : none
3831
3832 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3833 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3834 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3835 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3836
3837 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3838 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3839 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3840 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3841
3842 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3843 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3844 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3845 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3846 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3847
3848 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3849
3850 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3851 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3852 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3853
3854 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3855 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3856
3857 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3858
3859
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003860option ssl-hello-chk
3861 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3863 yes | no | yes | yes
3864 Arguments : none
3865
3866 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3867 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3868 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3869 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3870 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3871 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3872 hello message.
3873
3874 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3875 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3876 messages, which is appreciable.
3877
3878 See also: "option httpchk"
3879
3880
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003881option tcp-smart-accept
3882no option tcp-smart-accept
3883 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3885 yes | yes | yes | no
3886 Arguments : none
3887
3888 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3889 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3890 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3891 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3892 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3893 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3894
3895 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3896 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3897 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3898 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3899
3900 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3901 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3902 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3903 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3904
3905 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3906 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3907 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3908
3909 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3910 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3911 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3912
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003913 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3914
3915
3916option tcp-smart-connect
3917no option tcp-smart-connect
3918 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3920 yes | no | yes | yes
3921 Arguments : none
3922
3923 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3924 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3925 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3926 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3927 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3928
3929 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3930 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3931 complex.
3932
3933 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
3934 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
3935 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
3936
3937 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3938 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3939
3940 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
3941
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003942
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003943option tcpka
3944 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
3945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3946 yes | yes | yes | yes
3947 Arguments : none
3948
3949 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3950 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3951 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3952 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3953
3954 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3955 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3956 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3957 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3958
3959 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3960 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3961 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3962 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3963 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3964
3965 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3966
3967 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
3968 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
3969 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
3970 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
3971 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
3972 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
3973 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
3974 backends.
3975
3976 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
3977
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003978
3979option tcplog
3980 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
3981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3982 yes | yes | yes | yes
3983 Arguments : none
3984
3985 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3986 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3987 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
3988 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
3989 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
3990 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
3991 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
3992 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
3993
3994 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003996 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003997
3998
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003999option transparent
4000no option transparent
4001 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004003 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004004 Arguments : none
4005
4006 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4007 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4008 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4009 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4010 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4011 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4012 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4013 appropriate server.
4014
4015 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4016 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4017
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004018 See also: the "usersrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
4019 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004020
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004021
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004022persist rdp-cookie
4023persist rdp-cookie(name)
4024 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4026 yes | no | yes | yes
4027 Arguments :
4028 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004029 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4030 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004031
4032 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4033 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4034 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4035 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4036 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4037 forwarded to this server.
4038
4039 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4040 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4041 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004042 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004043 a single "listen" section.
4044
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004045 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4046 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4047 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4048
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004049 Example :
4050 listen tse-farm
4051 bind :3389
4052 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4053 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4054 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4055 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4056 persist rdp-cookie
4057 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4058 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4059 balance rdp-cookie
4060 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4061 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4062
4063 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
4064
4065
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004066rate-limit sessions <rate>
4067 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4069 yes | yes | yes | no
4070 Arguments :
4071 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4072 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4073
4074 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4075 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4076 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4077 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4078 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4079 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4080
4081 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4082 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4083 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4084 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4085
4086 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4087 listen smtp
4088 mode tcp
4089 bind :25
4090 rate-limit sessions 10
4091 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4092
4093 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
4094 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
4095
4096 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4097
4098
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004099redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4100redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004101 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4103 no | yes | yes | yes
4104
4105 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004106 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004107
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004108 Arguments :
4109 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4110 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4111 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4112 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004113 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4114 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4115 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4116 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004117
4118 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4119 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4120 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4121 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4122 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4123 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4124 location with a GET method.
4125
4126 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4127 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4128
4129 - "drop-query"
4130 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4131 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4132 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4133 with a location-type redirect.
4134
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004135 - "append-slash"
4136 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4137 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4138 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4139 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4140
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004141 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4142 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4143 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4144 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4145 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4146 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4147 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4148
4149 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4150 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4151 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4152 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4153 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4154 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4155 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004156
4157 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4158 acl clear dst_port 80
4159 acl secure dst_port 8080
4160 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004161 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004162 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004163 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4164
4165 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004166 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4167 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4168 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004169 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004170
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004171 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4172 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4173 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004175 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004176
4177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004178redisp (deprecated)
4179redispatch (deprecated)
4180 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4181 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4182 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004183 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004184
4185 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4186 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4187 be able to access the service anymore.
4188
4189 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4190 redistribute them to a working server.
4191
4192 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4193 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4194 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004195
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004196 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4197 "option redispatch" instead.
4198
4199 See also : "option redispatch"
4200
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004201
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004202reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004203 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4205 no | yes | yes | yes
4206 Arguments :
4207 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4208 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004209 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004210
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004211 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4212 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4213
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004214 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4215 the last header of an HTTP request.
4216
4217 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4218 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4219 responses.
4220
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004221 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4222 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4223 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4224
4225 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4226 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004227
4228
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004229reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4230reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004231 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4233 no | yes | yes | yes
4234 Arguments :
4235 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4236 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4237 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4238 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4239 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4240 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4241 ignores case.
4242
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004243 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4244 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4245
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004246 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4247 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4248 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4249 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004250 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004251
4252 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4253 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4254
4255 Example :
4256 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4257 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4258 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4259
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004260 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4261 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004262
4263
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004264reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4265reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004266 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 no | yes | yes | yes
4269 Arguments :
4270 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4271 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4272 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4273 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4274 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4275 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4276
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004277 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4278 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4279
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004280 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4281 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4282 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4283 next servers.
4284
4285 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4286 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4287 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4288
4289 Example :
4290 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4291 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4292 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4293
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004294 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4295 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004296
4297
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004298reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4299reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004300 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4302 no | yes | yes | yes
4303 Arguments :
4304 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4305 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4306 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4307 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4308 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4309 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4310 case.
4311
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004312 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4313 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4314
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004315 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4316 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4317 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4318 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004319 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004320
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004321 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004322 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004323 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004324
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004325 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4326 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4327
4328 Example :
4329 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4330 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4331 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4332
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004333 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4334 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004335
4336
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004337reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4338reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004339 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4341 no | yes | yes | yes
4342 Arguments :
4343 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4344 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4345 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4346 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4347 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4348 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4349 case.
4350
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004351 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4352 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4353
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004354 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4355 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4356 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4357 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4358
4359 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4360 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4361
4362 Example :
4363 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4364 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4365 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4366 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4367
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004368 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4369 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004370
4371
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004372reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4373reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004374 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4376 no | yes | yes | yes
4377 Arguments :
4378 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4379 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4380 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4381 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4382 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4383 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4384
4385 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4386 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4387 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4388 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004389 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004390
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004391 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4392 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4393
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004394 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4395 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4396 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4397
4398 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4399 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4400 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4401 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4402 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4403
4404 Example :
4405 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4406 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4407 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4408 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4409
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004410 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4411 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004412
4413
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004414reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4415reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004416 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4418 no | yes | yes | yes
4419 Arguments :
4420 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4421 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4422 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4423 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4424 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4425 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4426 ignores case.
4427
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004428 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4429 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4430
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004431 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4432 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004433 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4434 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4435 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004436 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4437 not set.
4438
4439 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4440 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4441 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4442 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4443 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4444
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004445 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004446 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4447 # block all others.
4448 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4449 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4450
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004451 # block bad guys
4452 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4453 reqitarpit . if badguys
4454
4455 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4456 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004457
4458
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004459retries <value>
4460 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4461 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4462 yes | no | yes | yes
4463 Arguments :
4464 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4465 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4466 default value is 3.
4467
4468 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4469 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4470 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4471
4472 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4473 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4474
4475 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4476 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4477
4478 See also : "option redispatch"
4479
4480
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004481rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004482 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4484 no | yes | yes | yes
4485 Arguments :
4486 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4487 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004488 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004489
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004490 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4491 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4492
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004493 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4494 the last header of an HTTP response.
4495
4496 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4497 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4498 responses.
4499
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004500 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4501 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004502
4503
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004504rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4505rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004506 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 no | yes | yes | yes
4509 Arguments :
4510 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4511 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4512 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4513 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4514 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4515 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4516 ignores case.
4517
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004518 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4519 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4520
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004521 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4522 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4523 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4524 client.
4525
4526 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4527 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4528 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4529
4530 Example :
4531 # remove the Server header from responses
4532 reqidel ^Server:.*
4533
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004534 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4535 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004536
4537
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004538rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4539rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004540 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4542 no | yes | yes | yes
4543 Arguments :
4544 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4545 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4546 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4547 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4548 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4549 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4550 ignores case.
4551
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004552 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4553 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4554
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004555 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4556 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4557 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4558 case-sensitive.
4559
4560 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004561 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4562 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4563 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004564
4565 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4566 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4567
4568 Example :
4569 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4570 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4571
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004572 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4573 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004574
4575
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004576rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4577rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004578 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4580 no | yes | yes | yes
4581 Arguments :
4582 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4583 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4584 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4585 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4586 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4587 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4588 ignores case.
4589
4590 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4591 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4592 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4593 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004594 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004595
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004596 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4597 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4598
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004599 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4600 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4601 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4602
4603 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4604 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4605 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4606 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4607 are not case-sensitive.
4608
4609 Example :
4610 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4611 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4612
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004613 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4614 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004615
4616
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004617server <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
4618 Declare a server in a backend
4619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 no | no | yes | yes
4621 Arguments :
4622 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4623 appear in logs and alerts.
4624
4625 <address> is the IPv4 address of the server. Alternatively, a resolvable
4626 hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved during
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004627 start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning. It
4628 indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
4629 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4630 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4631 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4632 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4633 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4634 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004635
4636 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4637 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4638 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4639 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4640 adding this value to the client's port.
4641
4642 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4643 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004644 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004645
4646 Examples :
4647 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4648 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4649
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004650 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004651
4652
4653source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004654source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004655source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004656 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4658 yes | no | yes | yes
4659 Arguments :
4660 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4661 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4662 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4663 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4664
4665 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4666 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004667 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4668 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4669 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004670
4671 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4672 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4673 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4674 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4675 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4676 <addr>.
4677
4678 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4679 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4680 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4681 port.
4682
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004683 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4684 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4685 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4686 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4687 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4688 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4689 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4690 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4691 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4692 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4693 HTTP header.
4694
4695 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4696 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4697 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4698 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4699 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4700 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4701 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4702 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4703 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4704 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4705
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004706 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4707 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4708 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4709 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4710 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4711 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4712
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004713 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4714 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4715 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4716 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4717
4718 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4719 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4720 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4721 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4722 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4723 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4724
4725 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4726 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4727 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4728 there are two methods :
4729
4730 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4731 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4732 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4733 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4734 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4735 of the client ranges may be used.
4736
4737 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4738 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4739 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4740 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4741 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4742 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4743 same session.
4744
4745 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4746 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4747 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4748 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4749 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4750 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4751
4752 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4753 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4754 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004755 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004756
4757 Examples :
4758 backend private
4759 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4760 source 192.168.1.200
4761
4762 backend transparent_ssl1
4763 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4764 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4765
4766 backend transparent_ssl2
4767 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4768 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4769 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4770
4771 backend transparent_ssl3
4772 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4773 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4774 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4775
4776 backend transparent_smtp
4777 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4778 # with Tproxy version 4.
4779 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4780
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004781 backend transparent_http
4782 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4783 # proxy.
4784 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004786 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004787 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4788
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004789
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004790srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4791 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 yes | no | yes | yes
4794 Arguments :
4795 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4796 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4797 as explained at the top of this document.
4798
4799 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4800 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4801 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4802 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4803 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4804 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4805 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4806
4807 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4808 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4809 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4810 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4811 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004812 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004813 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004814 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004815
4816 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4817 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4818 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4819 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4820 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4821 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4822
4823 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4824 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4825
4826 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4827
4828
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004829stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4830 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4832 no | no | yes | yes
4833
4834 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4835 matched.
4836
4837 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4838 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4839
4840 Currently, there are 2 known limitations :
4841
4842 - The POST data are limited to one packet, which means that if the list of
4843 servers is too long, the request won't be processed. It is recommended
4844 to alter few servers at a time.
4845
4846 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported.
4847
4848 Example :
4849 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4850 backend stats_localhost
4851 stats enable
4852 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4853
4854 Example :
4855 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4856 backend stats_auth
4857 stats enable
4858 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4859 stats admin if TRUE
4860
4861 Example :
4862 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4863 userlist stats-auth
4864 group admin users admin
4865 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4866 group readonly users haproxy
4867 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4868
4869 backend stats_auth
4870 stats enable
4871 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4872 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4873 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4874 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4875
4876 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
4877 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
4878
4879
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004880stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4881 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4883 yes | no | yes | yes
4884 Arguments :
4885 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4886
4887 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4888
4889 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4890 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4891 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4892 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4893 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4894 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4895
4896 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4897 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4898 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4899 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4900
4901 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4902 report using "stats scope".
4903
4904 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4905 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4906 unobvious parameters.
4907
4908 Example :
4909 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4910 backend public_www
4911 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4912 stats enable
4913 stats hide-version
4914 stats scope .
4915 stats uri /admin?stats
4916 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4917 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4918 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4919
4920 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4921 backend private_monitoring
4922 stats enable
4923 stats uri /admin?stats
4924 stats refresh 5s
4925
4926 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4927
4928
4929stats enable
4930 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
4931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4932 yes | no | yes | yes
4933 Arguments : none
4934
4935 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
4936 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
4937 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
4938 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
4939 - stats auth : no authentication
4940 - stats scope : no restriction
4941
4942 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4943 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4944 unobvious parameters.
4945
4946 Example :
4947 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4948 backend public_www
4949 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4950 stats enable
4951 stats hide-version
4952 stats scope .
4953 stats uri /admin?stats
4954 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4955 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4956 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4957
4958 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4959 backend private_monitoring
4960 stats enable
4961 stats uri /admin?stats
4962 stats refresh 5s
4963
4964 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4965
4966
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004967stats hide-version
4968 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4970 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004971 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004972
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004973 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
4974 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
4975 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
4976 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
4977 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
4978 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004980 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4981 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4982 unobvious parameters.
4983
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004984 Example :
4985 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4986 backend public_www
4987 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004988 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004989 stats hide-version
4990 stats scope .
4991 stats uri /admin?stats
4992 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4993 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4994 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004995
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004996 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4997 backend private_monitoring
4998 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004999 stats uri /admin?stats
5000 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005001
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005002 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005003
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005004
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005005stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5006 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5007 Access control for statistics
5008
5009 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5010 no | no | yes | yes
5011
5012 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5013 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5014 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5015 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5016 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5017 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5018
5019 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5020 instance.
5021
5022 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5023 about ACL usage.
5024
5025
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005026stats realm <realm>
5027 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5029 yes | no | yes | yes
5030 Arguments :
5031 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5032 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5033 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5034
5035 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5036 using a backslash ('\').
5037
5038 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5039 only related to authentication.
5040
5041 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5042 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5043 unobvious parameters.
5044
5045 Example :
5046 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5047 backend public_www
5048 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5049 stats enable
5050 stats hide-version
5051 stats scope .
5052 stats uri /admin?stats
5053 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5054 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5055 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5056
5057 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5058 backend private_monitoring
5059 stats enable
5060 stats uri /admin?stats
5061 stats refresh 5s
5062
5063 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5064
5065
5066stats refresh <delay>
5067 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5069 yes | no | yes | yes
5070 Arguments :
5071 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5072 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5073 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5074 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5075 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5076 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5077
5078 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5079 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5080 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5081 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5082
5083 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5084 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5085 unobvious parameters.
5086
5087 Example :
5088 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5089 backend public_www
5090 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5091 stats enable
5092 stats hide-version
5093 stats scope .
5094 stats uri /admin?stats
5095 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5096 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5097 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5098
5099 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5100 backend private_monitoring
5101 stats enable
5102 stats uri /admin?stats
5103 stats refresh 5s
5104
5105 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5106
5107
5108stats scope { <name> | "." }
5109 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5111 yes | no | yes | yes
5112 Arguments :
5113 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5114 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5115 section in which the statement appears.
5116
5117 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5118 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5119 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5120 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5121 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5122 exists.
5123
5124 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5125 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5126 unobvious parameters.
5127
5128 Example :
5129 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5130 backend public_www
5131 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5132 stats enable
5133 stats hide-version
5134 stats scope .
5135 stats uri /admin?stats
5136 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5137 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5138 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5139
5140 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5141 backend private_monitoring
5142 stats enable
5143 stats uri /admin?stats
5144 stats refresh 5s
5145
5146 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5147
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005148
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005149stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005150 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5152 yes | no | yes | yes
5153
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005154 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005155 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5156
5157 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5158 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5159
5160 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5161 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5162 unobvious parameters.
5163
5164 Example :
5165 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5166 backend private_monitoring
5167 stats enable
5168 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5169 stats uri /admin?stats
5170 stats refresh 5s
5171
5172 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5173 global section.
5174
5175
5176stats show-legends
5177 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5178 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5179 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5180 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5181 - IP (socket, server)
5182 - cookie (backend, server)
5183
5184 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5185 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5186 unobvious parameters.
5187
5188 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5189
5190
5191stats show-node [ <name> ]
5192 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5194 yes | no | yes | yes
5195 Arguments:
5196 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5197 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5198
5199 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5200 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5201 provided for each customer.
5202
5203 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5204 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5205 unobvious parameters.
5206
5207 Example:
5208 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5209 backend private_monitoring
5210 stats enable
5211 stats show-node Europe-1
5212 stats uri /admin?stats
5213 stats refresh 5s
5214
5215 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5216 section.
5217
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005218
5219stats uri <prefix>
5220 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5222 yes | no | yes | yes
5223 Arguments :
5224 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5225 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5226 query string.
5227
5228 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5229 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5230 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5231 possible to reach it in the application.
5232
5233 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005234 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005235 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5236 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5237 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5238 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5239
5240 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5241 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5242 an address or a port to statistics only.
5243
5244 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5245 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5246 unobvious parameters.
5247
5248 Example :
5249 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5250 backend public_www
5251 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5252 stats enable
5253 stats hide-version
5254 stats scope .
5255 stats uri /admin?stats
5256 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5257 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5258 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5259
5260 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5261 backend private_monitoring
5262 stats enable
5263 stats uri /admin?stats
5264 stats refresh 5s
5265
5266 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5267
5268
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005269stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5270 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005272 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005273
5274 Arguments :
5275 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5276 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5277 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5278 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5279
5280 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5281 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5282 the "stick-table" statement.
5283
5284 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5285 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5286 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5287 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5288 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5289
5290 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5291 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5292 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5293 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5294 transformation rules.
5295
5296 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5297 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5298 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5299 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5300 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5301 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5302 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5303
5304 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5305 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5306 ACL based conditions.
5307
5308 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5309 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5310 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5311 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5312
5313 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5314 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5315 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5316 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5317
5318 Example :
5319 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5320 # last 30 minutes
5321 backend pop
5322 mode tcp
5323 balance roundrobin
5324 stick store-request src
5325 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5326 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5327 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5328
5329 backend smtp
5330 mode tcp
5331 balance roundrobin
5332 stick match src table pop
5333 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5334 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5335
5336 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5337 extraction.
5338
5339
5340stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5341 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5343 no | no | yes | yes
5344
5345 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5346 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5347 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5348 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5349
5350 Examples :
5351 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005352 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005353
5354 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5355 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5356 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5357
5358
5359 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5360 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5361 backend http
5362 mode http
5363 balance roundrobin
5364 stick on src table https
5365 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5366 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5367 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5368
5369 backend https
5370 mode tcp
5371 balance roundrobin
5372 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5373 stick on src
5374 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5375 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5376
5377 See also : "stick match" and "stick store-request"
5378
5379
5380stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5381 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5383 no | no | yes | yes
5384
5385 Arguments :
5386 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5387 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5388 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5389 server is selected.
5390
5391 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5392 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5393 the "stick-table" statement.
5394
5395 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5396 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5397 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5398 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5399 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5400 address.
5401
5402 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5403 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5404 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5405 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5406 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5407 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5408 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5409 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5410 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5411 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5412
5413 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5414 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5415 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5416 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5417 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5418 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5419 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5420
5421 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5422 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5423 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5424 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5425
5426 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5427 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5428 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5429 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5430 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5431 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5432 another protocol or access method.
5433
5434 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5435 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5436 the request.
5437
5438 Example :
5439 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5440 # last 30 minutes
5441 backend pop
5442 mode tcp
5443 balance roundrobin
5444 stick store-request src
5445 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5446 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5447 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5448
5449 backend smtp
5450 mode tcp
5451 balance roundrobin
5452 stick match src table pop
5453 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5454 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5455
5456 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5457 extraction.
5458
5459
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005460stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005461 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5462 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005463 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005465 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005466
5467 Arguments :
5468 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5469 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5470 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5471 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5472
5473 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5474 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5475 instance.
5476
5477 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5478 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5479 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5480 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5481 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5482 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005483 to 32 characters.
5484
5485 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5486 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5487 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5488 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5489 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5490 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005491
5492 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005493 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5494 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005495 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5496 increase.
5497
5498 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005499 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5500 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5501 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005502
5503 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5504 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5505 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5506 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5507 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5508 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5509 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5510 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5511 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5512 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5513 parameter (see below).
5514
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005515 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5516 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5517 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5518 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5519 soft restart.
5520
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005521 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5522 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5523 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5524 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5525 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5526 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5527 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5528 if not expiration delay is specified.
5529
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005530 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5531 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5532 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5533 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005534 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5535 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5536 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5537 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5538 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5539 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5540 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5541 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5542 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5543 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5544 types and their arguments.
5545
5546 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5547 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5548 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5549 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5550
5551 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5552 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5553 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5554 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5555
5556 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5557 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5558 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5559 they were received.
5560
5561 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5562 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5563 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5564 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5565 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5566
5567 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5568 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5569 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5570 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5571 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5572
5573 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5574 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5575 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5576
5577 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5578 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5579 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5580 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5581 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5582
5583 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5584 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5585 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5586 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5587 the client side.
5588
5589 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5590 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5591 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5592 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5593 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5594 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5595 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5596
5597 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5598 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5599 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5600 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5601 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5602 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5603 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5604
5605 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5606 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5607 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5608 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5609 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5610 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5611
5612 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5613 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5614 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5615 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5616
5617 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5618 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5619 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5620 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5621 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5622 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5623 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5624 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5625 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5626 recommended for better fairness.
5627
5628 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5629 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5630 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5631 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5632
5633 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5634 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5635 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5636 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5637 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5638 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5639 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5640 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5641 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5642 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005643
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005644 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5645 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005646 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5647 reference it.
5648
5649 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5650 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5651 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5652 as an exclusive stickiness.
5653
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005654 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5655 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5656 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5657 something that can be ignored.
5658
5659 Example:
5660 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5661 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5662 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5663 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5664
5665 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
5666 about time format and section 7 avoud ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005667
5668
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005669stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5670 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5672 no | no | yes | yes
5673
5674 Arguments :
5675 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5676 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5677 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5678 server is selected.
5679
5680 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5681 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5682 the "stick-table" statement.
5683
5684 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5685 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5686 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5687 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5688
5689 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5690 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5691 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5692 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5693 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5694 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5695 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5696 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5697 rules.
5698
5699 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5700 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5701 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5702 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5703 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5704 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5705 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5706
5707 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5708 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5709 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5710 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5711
5712 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5713 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5714 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5715 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5716 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5717 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5718 another protocol or access method.
5719
5720 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5721
5722 Example :
5723 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5724 backend https
5725 mode tcp
5726 balance roundrobin
5727 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5728 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5729
5730 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5731 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5732
5733 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5734 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5735 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5736
5737 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5738 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5739
5740 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5741 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5742 # at offset 44.
5743
5744 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5745 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5746
5747 # Learn on response if server hello.
5748 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5749
5750 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5751 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5752
5753 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5754 extraction.
5755
5756
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005757tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5758 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5760 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005761 Arguments :
5762 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5763 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5764 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005765
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005766 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005767
5768 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5769 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005770 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5771 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5772 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5773 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5774 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5775 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005776
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005777 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5778 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5779 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5780 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005781
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005782 Three types of actions are supported :
5783 - accept :
5784 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5785 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5786 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005787
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005788 - reject :
5789 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5790 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5791 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5792 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5793 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5794 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5795 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5796 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5797 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5798 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5799 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5800 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005801
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005802 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5803 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5804 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5805 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5806 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5807 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5808 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5809 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5810 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005811
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005812 These actions take one or two arguments :
5813 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5814 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5815 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005816
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005817 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5818 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5819 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5820 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005821
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005822 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5823 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5824 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5825 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5826 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5827 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5828 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5829 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5830 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5831 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005832
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005833 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5834 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5835 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005836
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005837 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5838 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5839 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005840
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005841 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005842 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005843 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005844
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005845 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5846 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5847 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005848
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005849 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5850 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5851 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005852
5853 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5854
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005855 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005856
5857
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005858tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5859 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005861 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005862 Arguments :
5863 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5864 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5865 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005866
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005867 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005868
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005869 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5870 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5871 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5872 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5873 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005874
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005875 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5876 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5877 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5878 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5879 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5880 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5881 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5882 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5883 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005884
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005885 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5886 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5887 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5888 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005889
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005890 Three types of actions are supported :
5891 - accept :
5892 - reject :
5893 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005894
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005895 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5896 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005897
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005898 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5899 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5900 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5901 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5902 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5903 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005905 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005906 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5907 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005908
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005909 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5910 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5911 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
5912 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
5913 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005914
5915 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005916 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
5917 # and reject everything else.
5918 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
5919 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5920 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
5921 tcp-request content reject
5922
5923 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005924 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
5925 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5926 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005927 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005928
5929 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
5930 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5931 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005932 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005933 tcp-request content reject
5934
5935 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
5936 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
5937
5938 frontend http
5939 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
5940 # protecting all our sites
5941 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
5942 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5943 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
5944 ...
5945 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
5946
5947 backend http_dynamic
5948 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
5949 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
5950 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
5951 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
5952 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
5953 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
5954 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005956 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005957
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005958 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005959
5960
5961tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
5962 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
5963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005964 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005965 Arguments :
5966 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5967 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5968 as explained at the top of this document.
5969
5970 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
5971 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
5972 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
5973 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
5974 data for at most the specified amount of time.
5975
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005976 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
5977 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
5978 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
5979 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
5980
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005981 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
5982 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005983 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005984 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01005985 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
5986 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
5987 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
5988 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005989
5990 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
5991 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
5992 it pass through unaffected.
5993
5994 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
5995 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
5996 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005997 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005998 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
5999 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006000 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6001 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6002 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006003
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006004 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006005 "timeout client".
6006
6007
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006008tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6009 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6011 no | no | yes | yes
6012 Arguments :
6013 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6014 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6015 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6016
6017 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6018
6019 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6020 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6021 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6022 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6023 set and expires with no matching rule.
6024
6025 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6026
6027 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6028 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6029 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6030 inserted.
6031
6032 Two types of actions are supported :
6033 - accept :
6034 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6035 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6036 the rules evaluation.
6037
6038 - reject :
6039 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6040 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6041 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6042
6043 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6044 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6045 for changing the default action to a reject.
6046
6047 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6048 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6049 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6050 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6051 period.
6052
6053 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6054
6055 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6056
6057
6058tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6059 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6061 no | no | yes | yes
6062 Arguments :
6063 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6064 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6065 as explained at the top of this document.
6066
6067 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6068
6069
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006070timeout check <timeout>
6071 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6072 established.
6073
6074 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6075 yes | no | yes | yes
6076 Arguments:
6077 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6078 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6079 as explained at the top of this document.
6080
6081 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6082 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6083 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6084 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006085 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6086 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6087 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006088
6089 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6090 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6091
6092 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6093 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006094 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006095
6096 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6097 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6098 forget about it.
6099
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006100 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6101 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006102
6103
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006104timeout client <timeout>
6105timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6106 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6108 yes | yes | yes | no
6109 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006110 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006111 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6112 as explained at the top of this document.
6113
6114 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6115 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6116 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6117 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6118 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6119 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6120 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6121 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006122 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006123 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6124 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6125
6126 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6127 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6128 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6129 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6130 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6131 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6132
6133 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6134 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6135 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6136
6137 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6138
6139
6140timeout connect <timeout>
6141timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6142 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6144 yes | no | yes | yes
6145 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006146 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006147 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6148 as explained at the top of this document.
6149
6150 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006151 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006152 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006153 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006154 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6155 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006156
6157 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6158 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6159 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6160 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6161 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6162 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6163
6164 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6165 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6166 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6167
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006168 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6169 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006170
6171
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006172timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6173 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6175 yes | yes | yes | yes
6176 Arguments :
6177 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6178 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6179 as explained at the top of this document.
6180
6181 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6182 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6183 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6184 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6185 once the request has started to present itself.
6186
6187 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6188 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6189 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6190 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6191 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6192
6193 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6194 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6195 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6196 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6197
6198 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6199 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6200 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6201 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6202 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006203 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006204
6205 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6206 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6207 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6208 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6209
6210 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6211
6212
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006213timeout http-request <timeout>
6214 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006216 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006217 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006218 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006219 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6220 as explained at the top of this document.
6221
6222 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6223 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6224 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6225 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6226 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6227 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6228 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6229 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6230
6231 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6232 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006233 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6234 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006235
6236 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6237 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6238 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6239 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6240 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6241
6242 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006243 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6244 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6245 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006246
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006247 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006248
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006249
6250timeout queue <timeout>
6251 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6253 yes | no | yes | yes
6254 Arguments :
6255 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6256 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6257 as explained at the top of this document.
6258
6259 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6260 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6261 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6262 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6263 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6264
6265 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6266 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6267 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6268 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6269
6270 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6271
6272
6273timeout server <timeout>
6274timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6275 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6277 yes | no | yes | yes
6278 Arguments :
6279 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6280 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6281 as explained at the top of this document.
6282
6283 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6284 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6285 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6286 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6287 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6288 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6289 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6290
6291 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6292 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6293 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6294 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6295 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006296 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006297 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006298 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006299
6300 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6301 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6302 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6303 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6304 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6305 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6306
6307 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6308 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6309 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6310
6311 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6312
6313
6314timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006315 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6317 yes | yes | yes | yes
6318 Arguments :
6319 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6320 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6321 as explained at the top of this document.
6322
6323 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6324 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6325 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6326
6327 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6328 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6329 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6330 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006331 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006332
6333 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6334
6335
6336transparent (deprecated)
6337 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006339 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006340 Arguments : none
6341
6342 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6343 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6344 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6345 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6346 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6347 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6348 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6349 appropriate server.
6350
6351 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6352
6353 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6354 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6355
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006356 See also: "option transparent"
6357
6358
6359use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6360use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006361 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6363 no | yes | yes | no
6364 Arguments :
6365 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6366
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006367 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006368
6369 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6370 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6371 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006372 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6373 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6374 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6375 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006376
6377 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6378 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6379 assign the backend.
6380
6381 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6382 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6383 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6384 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6385 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6386 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6387
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006388 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006389 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006390 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6391 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6392 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6393
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006394 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006395
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010063975. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006398------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006400The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6401which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6402arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6403settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6404after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6405Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6406address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006408 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006409 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006411The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006413addr <ipv4>
6414 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6415 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6416 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6417 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6418 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006419
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006420 Supported in default-server: No
6421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006422backup
6423 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6424 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6425 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6426 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6427 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6428 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006429
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006430 Supported in default-server: No
6431
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006432check
6433 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6434 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6435 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6436 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6437 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6438 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6439 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6440 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6441 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006442 "mysql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and
6443 parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006444
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006445 Supported in default-server: No
6446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006447cookie <value>
6448 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6449 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6450 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6451 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6452 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6453 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6454 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006456 Supported in default-server: No
6457
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006458disabled
6459 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6460 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6461 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6462 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6463 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6464
6465 Supported in default-server: No
6466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006467error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006468 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6469 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6470 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006472 Supported in default-server: Yes
6473
6474 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006476fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006477 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6478 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6479 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006481 Supported in default-server: Yes
6482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006483id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006484 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6485 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6486 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006488 Supported in default-server: No
6489
6490inter <delay>
6491fastinter <delay>
6492downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006493 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6494 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6495 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6496 between checks depending on the server state :
6497
6498 Server state | Interval used
6499 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6500 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6501 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6502 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6503 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6504 or yet unchecked. |
6505 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6506 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6507 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006509 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6510 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6511 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6512 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6513 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6514 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6515 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6516 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6517 servers.
6518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006519 Supported in default-server: Yes
6520
6521maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006522 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6523 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6524 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6525 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6526 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6527 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6528 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6529 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6530
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006531 Supported in default-server: Yes
6532
6533maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006534 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6535 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6536 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6537 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6538 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6539 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6540 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6541
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006542 Supported in default-server: Yes
6543
6544minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006545 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6546 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6547 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6548 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6549 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6550 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006551 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006552 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006553
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006554 Supported in default-server: Yes
6555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006556observe <mode>
6557 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6558 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6559 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6560 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6561 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6562 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6563 headers, a timeout, etc.
6564
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006565 Supported in default-server: No
6566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006567 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006569on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006570 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6571 Currently, four modes are available:
6572 - fastinter: force fastinter
6573 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6574 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6575 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6576 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6577
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006578 Supported in default-server: Yes
6579
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006580 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6581
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006582port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006583 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6584 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6585 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6586 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6587 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6588 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006590 Supported in default-server: Yes
6591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006592redir <prefix>
6593 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6594 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6595 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6596 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6597 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6598 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6599 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6600 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006601 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006602 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6603 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6604 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6605 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6606 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6607
6608 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006610 Supported in default-server: No
6611
6612rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006613 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6614 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6615 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006617 Supported in default-server: Yes
6618
6619slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006620 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6621 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6622 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6623 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6624 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6625 parameters :
6626
6627 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6628 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6629
6630 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6631 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6632 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6633 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6634
6635 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6636 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6637 seen as failed.
6638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006639 Supported in default-server: Yes
6640
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006641source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006642source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006643source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006644 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6645 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6646 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6647 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6648
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006649 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6650 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6651 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6652 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6653 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6654 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6655 server.
6656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006657 Supported in default-server: No
6658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006659track [<proxy>/]<server>
6660 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6661 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6662 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6663 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6664 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006666 Supported in default-server: No
6667
6668weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006669 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6670 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6671 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006672 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6673 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6674 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6675 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6676 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6677 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006679 Supported in default-server: Yes
6680
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006681
66826. HTTP header manipulation
6683---------------------------
6684
6685In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6686response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6687request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6688which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6689against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6690to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6691passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6692headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6693never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6694
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006695There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6696(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6697rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6698messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6699in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006700happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006701add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6702normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006704This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6705in section 4.2 :
6706
6707 - reqadd <string>
6708 - reqallow <search>
6709 - reqiallow <search>
6710 - reqdel <search>
6711 - reqidel <search>
6712 - reqdeny <search>
6713 - reqideny <search>
6714 - reqpass <search>
6715 - reqipass <search>
6716 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6717 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6718 - reqtarpit <search>
6719 - reqitarpit <search>
6720 - rspadd <string>
6721 - rspdel <search>
6722 - rspidel <search>
6723 - rspdeny <search>
6724 - rspideny <search>
6725 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6726 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6727
6728With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6729is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6730parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6731prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6732Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6733
6734 \t for a tab
6735 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6736 \n for a new line (LF)
6737 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6738 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6739 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6740 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6741 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6742
6743The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6744portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6745above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6746regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
67479 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6748is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6749
6750The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6751after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6752
6753Notes related to these keywords :
6754---------------------------------
6755 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6756 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6757 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6758
6759 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6760 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6761 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6762
6763 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6764 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6765 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6766 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6767 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6768
6769 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6770 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6771 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6772 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6773 useless headers before adding new ones.
6774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006775 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006776 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6777
6778 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6779 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6780 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6781
6782 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6783 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006784 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006785
6786
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010067877. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6788------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006789
6790The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6791content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6792from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6793simple :
6794
6795 - define test criteria with sets of values
6796 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6797
6798The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6799
6800In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6801
6802 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6803
6804This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6805Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6806and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6807an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6808of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6809
6810ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6811'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6812which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6813
6814There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6815performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6816
6817The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6818
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006819 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6820 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006821 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6822
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006823The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6824specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6825possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006826multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6827be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6828needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6829space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6830match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6831lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6832duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6833to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6834instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006835
6836 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6837
6838In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6839the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6840case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6841too.
6842
6843Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6844a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6845ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006847Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006848
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006849 - integers or integer ranges
6850 - strings
6851 - regular expressions
6852 - IP addresses and networks
6853
6854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068557.1. Matching integers
6856----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006857
6858Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6859that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6860expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6861may be omitted.
6862
6863For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6864unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6865representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6866
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006867As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6868two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6869instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6870ranges and operators.
6871
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006872For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006873operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6874Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6875of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006876
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006877Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006878
6879 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6880 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6881 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6882 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6883 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6884
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006885For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006886
6887 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
6888
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006889This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
6890
6891 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
6892
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068947.2. Matching strings
6895---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006896
6897String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
6898exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
6899characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
6900string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
6901to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006902before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006903
6904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069057.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
6906-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006907
6908Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
6909they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
6910possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
6911passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
6912the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006913the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
6914match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006915
6916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069177.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
6918----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006919
6920IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
6921netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
6922within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006923host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006924difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
6925at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
6926does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
6927parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006928
6929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069307.5. Available matching criteria
6931--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069337.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
6934------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006935
6936A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
6937analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
6938addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
6939
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006940always_false
6941 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6942 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6943
6944always_true
6945 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6946 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6947
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006948avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006949avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006950 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
6951 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
6952 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
6953 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
6954 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
6955 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
6956 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
6957 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
6958 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
6959 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
6960 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01006961
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006962be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006963be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006964 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
6965 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
6966 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6967 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
6968 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006969
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006970be_sess_rate <integer>
6971be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
6972 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
6973 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
6974 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
6975 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
6976 sucking of an online dictionary).
6977
6978 Example :
6979 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
6980 backend dynamic
6981 mode http
6982 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
6983 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006984
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006985connslots <integer>
6986connslots(backend) <integer>
6987 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006988 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006989 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
6990
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006991 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
6992 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006993
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006994 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006995 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
6996 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
6997 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
6998 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
6999 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007000 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007001
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007002 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7003 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7004 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7005 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007006
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007007dst <ip_address>
7008 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7009 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007010
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007011dst_conn <integer>
7012 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7013 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7014 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7015 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7016 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7017 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7018
7019dst_port <integer>
7020 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7021 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7022
7023fe_conn <integer>
7024fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
7025 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7026 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7027 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7028 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7029 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7030 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7031 criteria.
7032
7033fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007034 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007035 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007036
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007037fe_sess_rate <integer>
7038fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
7039 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7040 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7041 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7042 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7043 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7044 the rate to go down below the limit.
7045
7046 Example :
7047 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7048 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7049 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7050 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7051 frontend mail
7052 bind :25
7053 mode tcp
7054 maxconn 100
7055 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7056 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7057 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7058 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007059
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007060nbsrv <integer>
7061nbsrv(backend) <integer>
7062 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7063 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7064 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7065 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7066 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007067
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007068queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02007069queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007070 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7071 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7072 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7073 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7074 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7075 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7076 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007078sc1_bytes_in_rate
7079sc2_bytes_in_rate
7080 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7081 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7082 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7083
7084sc1_bytes_out_rate
7085sc2_bytes_out_rate
7086 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7087 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7088 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7089
7090sc1_conn_cnt
7091sc2_conn_cnt
7092 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7093 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7094
7095sc1_conn_cur
7096sc2_conn_cur
7097 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7098 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7099 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7100
7101sc1_conn_rate
7102sc2_conn_rate
7103 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7104 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7105 See also src_conn_rate.
7106
7107sc1_get_gpc0
7108sc2_get_gpc0
7109 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7110 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7111
7112sc1_http_err_cnt
7113sc2_http_err_cnt
7114 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7115 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7116 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7117
7118sc1_http_err_rate
7119sc2_http_err_rate
7120 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7121 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7122 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7123 src_http_err_rate.
7124
7125sc1_http_req_cnt
7126sc2_http_req_cnt
7127 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7128 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7129 src_http_req_cnt.
7130
7131sc1_http_req_rate
7132sc2_http_req_rate
7133 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7134 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7135 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7136 src_http_req_rate.
7137
7138sc1_inc_gpc0
7139sc2_inc_gpc0
7140 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7141 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7142 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7143 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7144 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7145 when a first ACL was verified :
7146
7147 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7148 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7149 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7150
7151sc1_kbytes_in
7152sc2_kbytes_in
7153 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7154 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7155 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7156 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7157
7158sc1_kbytes_out
7159sc2_kbytes_out
7160 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7161 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7162 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7163 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7164
7165sc1_sess_cnt
7166sc2_sess_cnt
7167 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7168 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7169 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7170 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7171 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7172 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7173
7174sc1_sess_rate
7175sc2_sess_rate
7176 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7177 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7178 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7179 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7180 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7181 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7182
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007183so_id <integer>
7184 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7185
7186src <ip_address>
7187 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7188 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7189 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7190
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007191src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
7192src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
7193 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7194 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7195 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007196 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007197
7198src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
7199src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
7200 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7201 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7202 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007203 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007204
7205src_conn_cnt <integer>
7206src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
7207 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7208 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7209 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007210 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007211
7212src_conn_cur <integer>
7213src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
7214 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7215 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7216 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007217 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007218
7219src_conn_rate <integer>
7220src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
7221 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7222 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7223 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007224 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007225
7226src_get_gpc0 <integer>
7227src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
7228 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7229 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7230 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007231 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007232
7233src_http_err_cnt <integer>
7234src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
7235 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7236 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7237 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007238 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007239
7240src_http_err_rate <integer>
7241src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
7242 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7243 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7244 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7245 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007246 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007247
7248src_http_req_cnt <integer>
7249src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
7250 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7251 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7252 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007253 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007254
7255src_http_req_rate <integer>
7256src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
7257 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7258 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7259 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7260 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007261 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007262
7263src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
7264src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
7265 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7266 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7267 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7268 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7269 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7270 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7271
7272 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7273 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007274 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007275
7276src_kbytes_in <integer>
7277src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
7278 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7279 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7280 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7281 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007282 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007283
7284src_kbytes_out <integer>
7285src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
7286 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7287 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7288 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7289 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007290 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007291
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007292src_port <integer>
7293 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007294
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007295src_sess_cnt <integer>
7296src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
7297 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7298 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7299 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7300 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007301 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007302
7303src_sess_rate <integer>
7304src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
7305 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7306 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7307 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7308 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007309 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007310
7311src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
7312src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007313 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007314 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7315 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007316 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7317 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7318 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007319 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007320
7321 Example :
7322 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7323 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7324 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7325 listen ssh
7326 bind :22
7327 mode tcp
7328 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007329 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007330 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7331 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7332
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007333srv_is_up(<server>)
7334srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7335 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7336 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7337 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7338 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7339 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7340 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7341 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7342 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7343
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007344
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020073457.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7346---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007347
7348A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7349during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007350through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7351keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007352
7353req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007354 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007355 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7356 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7357 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7358 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7359 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7360 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7361
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007362req_proto_http
7363 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7364 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007365 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007366 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7367 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7368
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007369req_rdp_cookie <string>
7370req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
7371 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7372 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7373 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7374 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7375 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7376 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7377 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7378 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7379
7380req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
7381req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
7382 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7383 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7384 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7385 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7386 cookies.
7387
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007388req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7389 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7390 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7391 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7392 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7393 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7394 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7395 with TCP request content inspection.
7396
Emeric Brun392d1d82010-09-24 15:45:16 +02007397req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7398 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7399 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7400 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7401 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7402
7403rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7404 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7405 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7406 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7407 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7408
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007409wait_end
7410 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7411 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7412 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7413 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7414 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7415 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7416 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7417 inspection.
7418
7419 Examples :
7420 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7421 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7422 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7423
7424 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7425 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7426 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7427 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7428 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7429 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7430 tcp-request content reject
7431
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074337.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7434--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007435
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007436A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007437application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7438read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7439than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7440
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007441hdr <string>
7442hdr(header) <string>
7443 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7444 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7445 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7446 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7447 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7448
7449 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7450 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7451 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7452
7453 hdr(Connection) -i close
7454
7455hdr_beg <string>
7456hdr_beg(header) <string>
7457 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7458 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7459 response headers sent by the server.
7460
7461hdr_cnt <integer>
7462hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7463 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7464 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7465 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7466 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7467 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7468 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7469 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7470
7471hdr_dir <string>
7472hdr_dir(header) <string>
7473 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7474 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7475 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7476 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7477 headers sent by the server.
7478
7479hdr_dom <string>
7480hdr_dom(header) <string>
7481 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7482 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7483 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7484 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7485 server.
7486
7487hdr_end <string>
7488hdr_end(header) <string>
7489 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7490 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7491 response headers sent by the server.
7492
7493hdr_ip <ip_address>
7494hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7495 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7496 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7497 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7498 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7499
7500hdr_reg <regex>
7501hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7502 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7503 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7504 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7505 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7506 response headers sent by the server.
7507
7508hdr_sub <string>
7509hdr_sub(header) <string>
7510 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7511 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7512 response headers sent by the server.
7513
7514hdr_val <integer>
7515hdr_val(header) <integer>
7516 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7517 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7518 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7519 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7520
7521http_auth(userlist)
7522http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7523 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7524 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7525 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7526 of specified groups.
7527
7528 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7529
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007530http_req_first
7531 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7532 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7533 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7534 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007536method <string>
7537 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7538 already check for most common methods.
7539
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007540path <string>
7541 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7542 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7543 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7544
7545path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007546 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7547 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007548
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007549path_dir <string>
7550 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7551 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7552 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7553 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7554
7555path_dom <string>
7556 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7557 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7558 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7559
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007560path_end <string>
7561 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7562 control file name extension.
7563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007564path_reg <regex>
7565 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7566 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7567 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7568
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007569path_sub <string>
7570 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7571 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7572 "path_dir".
7573
7574req_ver <string>
7575 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7576 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7577
7578status <integer>
7579 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7580 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7581 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7582
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007583url <string>
7584 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7585 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7586
7587url_beg <string>
7588 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7589 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7590
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007591url_dir <string>
7592 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7593 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7594 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7595 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7596
7597url_dom <string>
7598 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7599 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7600 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7601
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007602url_end <string>
7603 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7604 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007605
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007606url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007607 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7608 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007609 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007610
7611url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007612 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7613 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007614 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007615 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007616
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007617url_reg <regex>
7618 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7619 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7620 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007621
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007622url_sub <string>
7623 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7624 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007625
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076277.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7628---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007630Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7631every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007632order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007634ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7635---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007636FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007637HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007638HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7639HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007640HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7641HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7642HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7643HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7644LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007645METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7646METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7647METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7648METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7649METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7650METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007651RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007652REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007653TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007654WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7655---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007656
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076587.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7659----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007661Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7662combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007664 - AND (implicit)
7665 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7666 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007668A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007670 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007672Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7673indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007675For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7676"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7677requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7678is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007680 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7681 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7682 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7683 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007685To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7686and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007688 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7689 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7690 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7691 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007693 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7694 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7695 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7696 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007697
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007698It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7699expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7700be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7701the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7702
7703 The following rule :
7704
7705 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7706 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7707
7708 Can also be written that way :
7709
7710 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7711
7712It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7713to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7714simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7715sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7716good use is the following :
7717
7718 With named ACLs :
7719
7720 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7721 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7722 monitor fail if site_dead
7723
7724 With anonymous ACLs :
7725
7726 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007728See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007729
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007730
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010077317.8. Pattern extraction
7732-----------------------
7733
7734The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7735response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7736for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7737
7738All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7739"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7740begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7741arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7742much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7743equivalent used in ACLs.
7744
7745The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7746
7747 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
7748 It is of type IP and only works with such tables.
7749
7750 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7751 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7752 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
7753 typie IP and only works with such tables.
7754
7755 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7756 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7757 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7758 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7759 type integer and only works with such tables.
7760
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007761 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7762 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7763 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7764 x-forwarded-for header.
7765
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007766 payload(offset,length)
7767 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
7768 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
7769 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
7770 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007771
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007772 payload_lv(offset1,length[,offset2])
7773 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
7774 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
7775 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
7776 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
7777 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
7778 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
7779 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
7780 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
7781
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007782The currently available list of transformations include :
7783
7784 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7785 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7786 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7787
7788 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7789 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7790 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7791
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007792 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7793 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7794 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7795 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7796 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7797
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077998. Logging
7800----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007801
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007802One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7803provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7804very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7805provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7806state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007807to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007808headers.
7809
7810In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7811about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7812send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7813
7814 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7815 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7816 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7817 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7818 at the termination.
7819
7820The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7821allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7822as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7823while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7824real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7825delay.
7826
7827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078288.1. Log levels
7829---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007830
7831TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with informations such as date, time,
7832source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
7833HTTP request, the HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, the conditions
7834in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values, to track a
7835particular user's problems for example. All messages are sent to up to two
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007836syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more info about log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007837facilities.
7838
7839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078408.2. Log formats
7841----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007842
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007843HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007844and will be detailed in the next sections. A few of them may slightly vary with
7845the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain options. The supported
7846formats are the following ones :
7847
7848 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7849 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7850 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
7851 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
7852 extents.
7853
7854 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
7855 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
7856 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
7857 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
7858 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
7859
7860 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
7861 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
7862 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
7863 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
7864 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
7865
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007866 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
7867 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
7868 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
7869 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
7870
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007871Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
7872specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
7873field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
7874servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
7875always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
7876identifier.
7877
7878Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
7879 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
7880 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
7881 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
7882 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
7883
7884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078858.2.1. Default log format
7886-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007887
7888This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
7889as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
7890format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
7891
7892 Example :
7893 listen www
7894 mode http
7895 log global
7896 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7897
7898 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
7899 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
7900 (www/HTTP)
7901
7902 Field Format Extract from the example above
7903 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
7904 2 'Connect from' Connect from
7905 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
7906 4 'to' to
7907 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
7908 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
7909
7910Detailed fields description :
7911 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
7912 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7913 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
7914 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
7915 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7916 and processed the connection.
7917 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
7918
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007919In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
7920"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
7921connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
7922
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007923It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
7924will eventually disappear.
7925
7926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079278.2.2. TCP log format
7928---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007929
7930The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
7931is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
7932information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
7933counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
7934emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
7935environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
7936the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
7937sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007938specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
7939not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
7940fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
7941marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007942
7943 Example :
7944 frontend fnt
7945 mode tcp
7946 option tcplog
7947 log global
7948 default_backend bck
7949
7950 backend bck
7951 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7952
7953 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
7954 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
7955 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
7956
7957 Field Format Extract from the example above
7958 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
7959 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
7960 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
7961 4 frontend_name fnt
7962 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
7963 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
7964 7 bytes_read* 212
7965 8 termination_state --
7966 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
7967 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7968
7969Detailed fields description :
7970 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007971 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
7972 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
7973 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
7974 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
7975 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007976
7977 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007978 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
7979 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
7980 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007981
7982 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
7983 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
7984 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
7985 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
7986
7987 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7988 and processed the connection.
7989
7990 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7991 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7992 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
7993 applications.
7994
7995 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
7996 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
7997 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
7998 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
7999 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8000
8001 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8002 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8003 See "Timers" below for more details.
8004
8005 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8006 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8007 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8008 "Timers" below for more details.
8009
8010 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8011 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8012 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8013 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8014 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8015 details.
8016
8017 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8018 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8019 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8020 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8021 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8022
8023 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8024 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8025 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8026 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8027 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8028 for more details.
8029
8030 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8031 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8032 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8033 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8034 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008035 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008036
8037 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8038 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8039 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8040 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8041 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8042 caused by a denial of service attack.
8043
8044 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8045 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8046 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8047 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8048 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8049 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8050 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8051 denial of service attack.
8052
8053 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8054 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8055 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8056 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8057 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8058 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8059 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8060 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8061 be processed than on other servers.
8062
8063 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8064 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8065 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8066 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8067 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8068 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8069 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8070 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8071 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8072 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8073 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8074 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8075 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8076
8077 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8078 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8079 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8080 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8081 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8082 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8083 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8084 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8085
8086 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8087 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8088 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8089 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8090 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8091 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8092 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8093 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8094 occurs.
8095
8096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080978.2.3. HTTP log format
8098----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008099
8100The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8101is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8102the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8103are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8104emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8105generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8106"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8107which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008108frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8109is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008110
8111Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8112slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8113with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8114
8115 Example :
8116 frontend http-in
8117 mode http
8118 option httplog
8119 log global
8120 default_backend bck
8121
8122 backend static
8123 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8124
8125 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8126 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8127 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008128 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008129
8130 Field Format Extract from the example above
8131 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8132 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8133 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8134 4 frontend_name http-in
8135 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8136 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8137 7 status_code 200
8138 8 bytes_read* 2750
8139 9 captured_request_cookie -
8140 10 captured_response_cookie -
8141 11 termination_state ----
8142 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8143 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8144 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8145 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8146 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008147
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008148
8149Detailed fields description :
8150 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008151 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8152 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8153 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8154 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8155 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008156
8157 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008158 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8159 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8160 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008161
8162 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8163 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8164 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8165 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8166 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8167
8168 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8169 and processed the connection.
8170
8171 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8172 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8173 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8174
8175 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8176 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8177 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8178 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8179 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8180 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8181
8182 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8183 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8184 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8185 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8186 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8187 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8188
8189 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8190 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8191 See "Timers" below for more details.
8192
8193 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8194 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8195 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8196 below for more details.
8197
8198 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8199 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8200 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8201 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8202 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8203 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8204 for more details.
8205
8206 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8207 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8208 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8209 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8210 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8211 details.
8212
8213 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8214 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8215 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8216
8217 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8218 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8219 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8220 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8221 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8222 overflowing.
8223
8224 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8225 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8226 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8227 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8228 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8229 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8230 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8231 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8232
8233 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8234 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8235 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8236 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8237 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8238 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8239 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8240 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8241
8242 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8243 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8244 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8245 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8246 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8247 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8248 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8249
8250 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8251 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8252 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8253 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8254 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008255 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008256 system.
8257
8258 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8259 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8260 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8261 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8262 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8263 caused by a denial of service attack.
8264
8265 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8266 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8267 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8268 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8269 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8270 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8271 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8272 denial of service attack.
8273
8274 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8275 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8276 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8277 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8278 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8279 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8280 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8281 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8282 processed than on other servers.
8283
8284 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8285 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8286 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8287 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8288 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8289 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8290 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8291 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8292 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8293 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8294 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8295 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8296 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8297
8298 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8299 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8300 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8301 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8302 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8303 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8304 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8305 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8306
8307 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8308 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8309 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8310 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8311 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8312 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8313 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8314 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8315 occurs.
8316
8317 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8318 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8319 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8320 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8321 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8322 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8323 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8324 cookies" below for more details.
8325
8326 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8327 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8328 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8329 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8330 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8331 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8332 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8333 and cookies" below for more details.
8334
8335 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8336 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8337 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8338 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8339 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8340 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8341 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8342 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8343
8344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083458.3. Advanced logging options
8346-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008347
8348Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8349just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8350options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8351for more information about their usage.
8352
8353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083548.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8355------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008356
8357It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8358haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8359commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8360monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8361ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8362
8363 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8364 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8365 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8366 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8367
8368 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8369 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8370 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8371 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8372 such as other load-balancers.
8373
8374 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8375 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8376 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8377
8378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083798.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8380----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008381
8382The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8383what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8384or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8385"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8386just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8387log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8388after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8389is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8390with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8391with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8392
8393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083948.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8395------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008396
8397Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8398for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8399"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8400retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8401raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8402a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8403file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8404you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8405"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8406
8407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8409--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008410
8411Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8412multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8413them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8414"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8415logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8416error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8417and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8418too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8419useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8420alternative.
8421
8422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084238.4. Timing events
8424------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008425
8426Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8427reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8428the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8429frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8430mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8431
8432 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8433 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8434 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8435 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8436 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8437
8438 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8439 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8440 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8441 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8442 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8443
8444 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8445 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8446 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8447 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8448 connection never established.
8449
8450 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8451 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8452 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8453 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8454 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8455 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8456 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8457 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8458 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8459 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8460 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8461
8462 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8463 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8464 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8465 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8466 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8467
8468 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8469
8470 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8471 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8472 negative.
8473
8474These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8475protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8476that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008477due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008478close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8479session has been aborted on timeout.
8480
8481Most common cases :
8482
8483 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8484 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8485 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8486 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8487 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8488 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8489 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8490 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8491 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008492 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8493 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8494 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008495
8496 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8497 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8498 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8499 of ms on remote networks.
8500
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008501 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8502 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8503 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008504
8505 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8506 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8507 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8508 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8509 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8510 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8511 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8512 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8513 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8514 to the server until another one is released.
8515
8516Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8517
8518 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8519 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8520 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8521
8522 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8523 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8524 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8525
8526 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8527 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8528 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8529 flags.
8530
8531 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8532 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8533 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8534 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8535 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8536 the client connection was maintained open.
8537
8538 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8539 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8540 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8541 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8542
8543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085448.5. Session state at disconnection
8545-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008546
8547TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8548"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
85492-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8550each of which has a special meaning :
8551
8552 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8553 session to terminate :
8554
8555 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8556
8557 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8558 server explicitly refused it.
8559
8560 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8561 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8562 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8563 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8564 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8565 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8566
8567 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8568 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8569 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8570 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8571 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8572
8573 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8574 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8575 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8576 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8577 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8578
8579 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8580 send or receive data.
8581
8582 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8583 send or receive data.
8584
8585 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8586 with nothing left in the buffers.
8587
8588 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8589
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01008590 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008591 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8592
8593 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8594 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8595 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8596 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8597 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8598
8599 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8600 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8601
8602 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8603 server (HTTP only).
8604
8605 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8606
8607 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8608 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8609 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8610
8611 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8612 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8613 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8614
8615 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8616
8617 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8618 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8619
8620 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8621 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8622 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8623
8624 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8625 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008626 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8627 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008628
8629 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8630 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8631 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8632 another server.
8633
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008634 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008635 server.
8636
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008637 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8638 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8639 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8640 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8641
8642 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8643 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8644 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8645 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8646
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008647 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8648
8649 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8650 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8651
8652 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8653
8654 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8655 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8656 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8657
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008658 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8659 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8660 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8661 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8662 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8663
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008664 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8665
8666 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8667 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8668
8669 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8670
8671 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8672
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008673The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8674was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008675helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8676starvation, attacks, etc...
8677
8678The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8679alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8680easier finding and understanding.
8681
8682 Flags Reason
8683
8684 -- Normal termination.
8685
8686 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8687 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8688 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8689 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8690
8691 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8692 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8693 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8694 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8695 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8696 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008697
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008698 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8699 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8700 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8701
8702 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8703 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8704 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8705
8706 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8707 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8708 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8709 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8710 the server takes too long to respond.
8711
8712 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8713 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8714 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8715 long a time to respond.
8716
8717 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8718 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8719 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8720 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8721 and the client.
8722
8723 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8724 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8725 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8726 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8727 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8728 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8729
8730 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8731 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008732 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8733 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8734 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8735 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008736
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008737 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008738 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8739 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8740 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8741 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8742 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8743
8744 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8745 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8746 503 or 504 here.
8747
8748 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8749 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8750 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8751 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8752 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8753
8754 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8755 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008756 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008757 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8758 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8759
8760 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8761 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8762 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8763 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8764 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8765 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8766 between haproxy and the server.
8767
8768 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8769 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8770 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8771 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8772 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8773 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8774 solution is to fix the application.
8775
8776 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8777 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8778 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8779 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8780 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8781 external attacks.
8782
8783 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8784 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8785 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8786 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8787 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8788
8789 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8790 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8791 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8792 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
8793 containing unauthorized characters.
8794
8795 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8796 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8797 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8798 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8799
8800 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8801 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8802 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8803 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8804
8805 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8806 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8807 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8808 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8809
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008810The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
8811persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
8812important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
8813re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
8814
8815 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
8816
8817 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8818 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
8819 set on a GET request.
8820
8821 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
8822 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
8823 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
8824 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
8825
8826 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
8827 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
8828 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
8829
8830 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8831 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
8832 already got a cookie.
8833
8834 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8835 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
8836 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
8837 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
8838 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
8839
8840 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8841 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8842 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8843
8844 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
8845 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8846 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8847
8848 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
8849 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
8850
8851 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
8852 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
8853 then advertised in the response.
8854
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088568.6. Non-printable characters
8857-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008858
8859In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
8860consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
8861converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
8862prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
8863being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
8864escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
8865is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
8866'}' when logging headers.
8867
8868Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
8869issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
8870containing spaces is "User-Agent".
8871
8872Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
8873the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
8874performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
8875
8876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088778.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
8878---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008879
8880Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
8881achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008882section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008883cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
8884the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
8885the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008886locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008887not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
8888user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
8889a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
8890wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
8891
8892 Examples :
8893 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
8894 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
8895
8896 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
8897 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
8898
8899
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089008.8. Capturing HTTP headers
8901---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008902
8903Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
8904proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
8905the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
8906server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
8907
8908Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
8909response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008910section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008911
8912It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008913time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
8914appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008915are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
8916and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
8917follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
8918request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
8919in the logs.
8920
8921 Example :
8922 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
8923 listen proxy-out
8924 mode http
8925 option httplog
8926 option logasap
8927 log global
8928 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
8929
8930 # log the name of the virtual server
8931 capture request header Host len 20
8932
8933 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
8934 capture request header Content-Length len 10
8935
8936 # log the beginning of the referrer
8937 capture request header Referer len 20
8938
8939 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
8940 capture response header Server len 20
8941
8942 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
8943 capture response header Content-Length len 10
8944
8945 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
8946 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
8947
8948 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
8949 capture response header Via len 20
8950
8951 # log the URL location during a redirection
8952 capture response header Location len 20
8953
8954 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
8955 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
8956 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8957 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
8958 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
8959
8960 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8961 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8962 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8963 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008964 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008965
8966 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8967 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8968 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8969 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
8970 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008971 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008972
8973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089748.9. Examples of logs
8975---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008976
8977These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
8978them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
8979reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
8980
8981 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
8982 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8983 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8984
8985 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
8986 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
8987
8988 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
8989 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
8990 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8991
8992 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
8993 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
8994
8995 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
8996 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8997 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8998
8999 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009000 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009001 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9002 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9003
9004 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9005 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9006 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9007
9008 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9009 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
9010 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
9011 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9012 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9013 to return the 502 and not the server.
9014
9015 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009016 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009017
9018 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9019 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9020 Nothing was sent to any server.
9021
9022 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9023 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9024
9025 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9026 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9027 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9028 send a 408 return code to the client.
9029
9030 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9031 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9032
9033 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9034 5 seconds ("c----").
9035
9036 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9037 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009038 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009039
9040 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009041 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009042 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9043 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9044 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9045 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9046 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009047
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090499. Statistics and monitoring
9050----------------------------
9051
9052It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9053mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9054CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9055Unix socket.
9056
9057
90589.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009059---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009060
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009061The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9062page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9063
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009064 0. pxname: proxy name
9065 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9066 for server)
9067 2. qcur: current queued requests
9068 3. qmax: max queued requests
9069 4. scur: current sessions
9070 5. smax: max sessions
9071 6. slim: sessions limit
9072 7. stot: total sessions
9073 8. bin: bytes in
9074 9. bout: bytes out
9075 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009076 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009077 12. ereq: request errors
9078 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009079 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009080 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9081 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009082 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009083 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9084 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9085 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9086 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9087 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9088 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9089 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9090 25. qlimit: queue limit
9091 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9092 27. iid: unique proxy id
9093 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9094 29. throttle: warm up status
9095 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9096 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009097 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009098 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9099 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9100 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009101 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009102 UNK -> unknown
9103 INI -> initializing
9104 SOCKERR -> socket error
9105 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9106 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9107 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9108 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9109 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9110 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9111 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9112 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9113 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9114 disable-on-404
9115 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9116 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9117 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009118 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9119 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009120 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9121 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9122 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9123 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9124 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9125 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009126 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9127 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9128 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9129 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009130 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9131 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009132
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091349.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009135-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009136
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009137The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009138must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9139is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9140a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9141risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9142followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9143given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9144then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9145to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009146
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009147It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9148on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9149own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009150
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009151clear counters
9152 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9153 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9154 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9155 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9156 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9157
9158clear counters all
9159 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9160 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9161 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9162
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009163clear table <table> key <key>
9164 Remove entry <key> from the stick-table <table>. The key must be of the same
9165 type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4. This is typically used
9166 un unblock some users complaining they have been abusively denied access to a
9167 service, but this can also be used to clear some stickiness entries matching
9168 a server that is going to be replaced (see "show table" below for details).
9169 Note that sometimes, removal of a key will be refused because it is currently
9170 tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds later after the session ends is
9171 usuall enough.
9172
9173 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009174 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009175 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009176 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9177 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9178 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9179 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009180
9181 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9182
9183 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009184 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009185 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9186 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009187
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009188disable server <backend>/<server>
9189 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9190 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9191 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9192 during the maintenance.
9193
9194 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9195 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9196
9197 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9198 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9199
9200 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9201 level "admin".
9202
9203enable server <backend>/<server>
9204 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9205 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9206
9207 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9208 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9209
9210 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9211 level "admin".
9212
9213get weight <backend>/<server>
9214 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9215 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9216 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9217 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9218 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
9219 dash ('#').
9220
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009221help
9222 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9223 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009224
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009225prompt
9226 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9227 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9228 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9229 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9230 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9231 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9232 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9233 command.
9234
9235quit
9236 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009237
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009238set timeout cli <delay>
9239 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9240 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9241 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9242
9243set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9244 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9245 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9246 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9247 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9248 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9249 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9250 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9251 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9252 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9253 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9254 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9255 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9256 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
9257 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9258
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009259show errors [<iid>]
9260 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9261 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009262 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9263 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9264 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009265
9266 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9267 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9268 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9269 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9270 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9271 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9272 are reported too.
9273
9274 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9275 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9276 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9277 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9278 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9279 code.
9280
9281 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9282 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9283 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9284 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9285 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9286 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9287 line.
9288
9289 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009290 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9291 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009292 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9293 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9294
9295 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9296 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9297 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9298 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9299 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9300 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9301 00204+ minal\r\n
9302 00211 \r\n
9303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009304 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009305 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9306 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9307 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9308 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9309 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9310 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009311
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009312show info
9313 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9314
9315show sess
9316 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009317 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9318 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9319
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009320show sess <id>
9321 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9322 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9323 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9324 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9325 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9326 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009327
9328show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9329 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9330 possible to dump only selected items :
9331 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9332 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9333 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9334 for example:
9335 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9336 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9337 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9338
9339 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009340 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9341 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009342 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9343 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9344 Nbproc: 1
9345 Process_num: 1
9346 (...)
9347
9348 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9349 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9350 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9351 (...)
9352 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9353
9354 $
9355
9356 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9357 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9358 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9359 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009360 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009361
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009362show table
9363 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9364 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9365 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9366 entries currently in use.
9367
9368 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009369 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9370 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
9371 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009372
9373show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ]
9374 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9375 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9376 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
9377 a filter in order to specify what entries to display. The filter then applies
9378 to the stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2). One stored data type
9379 has to be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table
9380 otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator>
9381 with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9382 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9383 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9384 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9385 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9386 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9387 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9388
9389 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009390 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9391 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9392 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9393 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9394 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9395 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009396
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009397 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9398 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9399 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9400 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009401
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009402 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9403 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9404 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9405 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9406 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009407
9408 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9409 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9410 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9411 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9412 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9413
9414 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9415 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9416 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009417 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9418 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009419 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9420 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009421
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009422/*
9423 * Local variables:
9424 * fill-column: 79
9425 * End:
9426 */